blob: e923736ab282ae5a36807724ef47de61d0200cb6 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Faulet6cfe7872023-12-14 14:50:17 +01006 2023/12/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
729before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730
731 Example:
732
733 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
734
735 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
736
737 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
738
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
740file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
743 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
744
745* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
746 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
747 directory.
748
749* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
750
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500751* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752 processes, separated by semicolons.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 CLI, separated by semicolons.
756
William Lallemanda48f51b2023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100757* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
758 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
759 updating the binary and reloading.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
817The conditions are currently limited to:
818
819 - an empty string, always returns "false"
820 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
821 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200822 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
823
824The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
825
826 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
827 exists, regardless of its contents
828
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200829 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
830 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
831 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
832
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200833 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
834 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
835
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200836 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
841 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
842 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
843 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
844 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
845
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200846Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
849 listen mwcli_px
850 bind :1111
851 ...
852 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100853
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200854 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
855 bind :80
856 .endif
857
858 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200859 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200860 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 .endif
863
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200864 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
865 profiling.memory on
866 .endif
867
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200868Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100869
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200870 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100871 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
872 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
873 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
874
875Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
876"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
877fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
878provide advice to the user.
879
880Example:
881
882 .if "${A}"
883 .if "${B}"
884 .notice "A=1, B=1"
885 .elif "${C}"
886 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
887 .elif "${D}"
888 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
889 .else
890 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
891 .endif
892 .else
893 .notice "A=0"
894 .endif
895
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200896 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
897 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
898
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100899
9002.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200901----------------
902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100903Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100904values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
905otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
906numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
907for every keyword. Supported units are :
908
909 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
910 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
911 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
912 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
913 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
914 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
915
916
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009172.6. Size format
918----------------
919
920Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
921These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
922otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
923numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
924for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
925
926 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
927 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
928 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
929
930Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
931
932
9332.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200934-------------
935
936 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
937 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
938 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
939 global
940 daemon
941 maxconn 256
942
943 defaults
944 mode http
945 timeout connect 5000ms
946 timeout client 50000ms
947 timeout server 50000ms
948
949 frontend http-in
950 bind *:80
951 default_backend servers
952
953 backend servers
954 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
955
956
957 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
958 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
959 global
960 daemon
961 maxconn 256
962
963 defaults
964 mode http
965 timeout connect 5000ms
966 timeout client 50000ms
967 timeout server 50000ms
968
969 listen http-in
970 bind *:80
971 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
972
973
974Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
975
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100976 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200977
978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009793. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980--------------------
981
982Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
983are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
984of them have command-line equivalents.
985
986The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
987
988 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - 51degrees-cache-size
990 - 51degrees-data-file
991 - 51degrees-property-name-list
992 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200995 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100996 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200997 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200998 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200999 - description
1000 - deviceatlas-json-file
1001 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001002 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001003 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001004 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001005 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - gid
1007 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001008 - h1-case-adjust
1009 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001010 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1011 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001012 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001013 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001014 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001015 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001017 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001018 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001020 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001021 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001022 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001024 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001025 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001026 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001028 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001029 - presetenv
1030 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001031 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001032 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001033 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001034 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001035 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001036 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001037 - ssl-default-bind-options
1038 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001039 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001040 - ssl-default-server-options
1041 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001042 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001043 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001044 - stats
1045 - strict-limits
1046 - uid
1047 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001048 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001049 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001050 - user
1051 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001052 - wurfl-data-file
1053 - wurfl-information-list
1054 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001055
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001057 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001058 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - maxcompcpuusage
1060 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001062 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001063 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001064 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001065 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001066 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001067 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001068 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001070 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001072 - nokqueue
1073 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001074 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001075 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001076 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001077 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001078 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001079 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001080 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001081 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001082 - tune.buffers.limit
1083 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001084 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001085 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001086 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet48110bc2023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001087 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001088 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001089 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001090 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001091 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhus1da7ab32023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001092 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001093 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001094 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001095 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001096 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001097 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001098 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001099 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001100 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1102 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001103 - tune.maxaccept
1104 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001105 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001106 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001107 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001108 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1109 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001110 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1111 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001112 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001113 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001114 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001115 - tune.sndbuf.client
1116 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001117 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001118 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1119 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1120 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001121 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001122 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1123 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001124 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001125 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001126 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001127 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1128 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1129 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001130 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1131 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001135 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
1137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011383.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001139------------------------------------
1140
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100114151degrees-data-file <file path>
1142 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1143 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1146 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1147
114851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1149 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1150 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1151 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1152
1153 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1154 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1155
115651degrees-property-separator <char>
1157 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1158 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1159
1160 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1161 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1162
116351degrees-cache-size <number>
1164 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1165 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1166 By default, this cache is disabled.
1167
1168 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1169 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1170
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001171ca-base <dir>
1172 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001173 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1174 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1175 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177chroot <jail dir>
1178 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1179 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1180 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1181 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1182 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001183 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001184
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001185cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1186 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1187 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1188 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1189 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1190 set. These sets have the format
1191
1192 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1193
1194 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001195 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1197 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001198 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1199 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001200 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1201 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1202 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1203 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1204 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1205 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1206 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1207 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1208 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1209 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001210
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001211 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1212 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1213 on the machine's word size.
1214
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001215 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1217 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1218 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1219 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1220 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1221 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001222
1223 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001224 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1225
1226 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1227 # first 4 CPUs
1228
1229 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1230 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1231 # word size.
1232
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001233 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001234 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001235 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1236 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1237 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1238
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001239 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1240 # and so on.
1241 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1242 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1243 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001245 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001246 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1247 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1248 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1249
1250 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1251 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1252 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1253
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001254 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1255 # and a thread range.
1256 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1257 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1258 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1259
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001260crt-base <dir>
1261 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001262 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1263 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001264
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001265daemon
1266 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1267 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001268 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1269 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001271default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001272 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001273 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1274 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1275 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1276 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1277 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1278 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1279 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1280 not start with a slash ('/'):
1281 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1282 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1283
1284 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1285 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1286 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1287 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1288 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1289 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1290 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1291 each of them.
1292
1293 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1294 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1295 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1296 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1297 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1298 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1299 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1300 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1301
1302 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1303 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001304 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001305 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1306 made easily relocatable.
1307
1308 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1309 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1310 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1311 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1312 consistent across all configuration files.
1313
1314 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1315 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1316 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1317 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1318 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1319 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1320 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1321 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1322
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001323description <text>
1324 Add a text that describes the instance.
1325
1326 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1327 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1328 "<" and ">" characters.
1329
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001330deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1331 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001332 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001333
1334deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001335 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001336 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1337
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001338deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001339 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1340 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1341 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001342
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001343deviceatlas-separator <char>
1344 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1345 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1346
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001347expose-experimental-directives
1348 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1349 the config file will be rejected.
1350
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001351external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001352 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1353 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001354 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1355 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1356 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1357 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1358 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001359
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001360gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001361 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001362 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1363 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001364 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001365 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001366 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001367
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001368group <group name>
1369 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1370 See also "gid" and "user".
1371
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001372h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1373 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1374 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1375 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1376 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001377 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001378 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1379 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1380 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1381 specified in a proxy.
1382
1383 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1384 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1385 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1386 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1387 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1388 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1389 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1390
1391 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1392 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1393 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1394 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1395 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1396
1397 Example:
1398 global
1399 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1400
1401 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1402 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1403
1404h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1405 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1406 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1407 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1408 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1409 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1410 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1411 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1412 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1413
1414 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1415 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1416 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1417
1418 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1419 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1420
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001421h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1422 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1423 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1424 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1425 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1426 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1427 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1428 the keyword with "no'.
1429
1430hard-stop-after <time>
1431 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1432
1433 Arguments :
1434 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1435 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1436 SIGUSR1 signal.
1437
1438 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1439 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1440 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1441
1442 Example:
1443 global
1444 hard-stop-after 30s
1445
1446 See also: grace
1447
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001448insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001449 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001450 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1451 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1452 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1453 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1454 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1455 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1456 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001457 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001458 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1459 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1460 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1461 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1462 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1463 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1464 disable it.
1465
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001466insecure-setuid-wanted
1467 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1468 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1469 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1470 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001471 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001472 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001473 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001474 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1475 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001476 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001477 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1478 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1479 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1480 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1481
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001482issuers-chain-path <dir>
1483 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1484 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1485 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001486 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001487 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1488 "issuers-chain-path".
1489 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1490 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1491 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1492 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1493 will share the chain in memory.
1494
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001495localpeer <name>
1496 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1497 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1498 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1499 the configuration parsing.
1500
1501 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1502 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1503
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001504log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001505 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001506 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001507 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001508 configured with "log global".
1509
1510 <address> can be one of:
1511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001512 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001513 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1514 port).
1515
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001516 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1517 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1518 port).
1519
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001520 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001521 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1522 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001523 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001524
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001525 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1526 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1527 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1528 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1529 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1530 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1531 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1532 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1533 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1534 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001535 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001536 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1537 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1538 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001539 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1540 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001541
1542 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1543 "fd@2", see above.
1544
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001545 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1546 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1547 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1548 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1549 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1550
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001551 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1552 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001553
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001554 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1555 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1556 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1557 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1558 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1559 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1560 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1561 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1562 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1563 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001564 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1565 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001566
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001567 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1568 one of the following :
1569
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001570 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1571 field is stripped. This is the default.
1572 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1573 rfc3164.
1574
1575 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001576 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1577
1578 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1579 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1580
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001581 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1582 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1583 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1584 designed to be used with a local log server.
1585
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001586 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1587 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1588 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1589 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1590 logger consumes.
1591
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001592 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1593 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1594 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1595 used with a local log server.
1596
1597 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1598 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1599 designed to be used with a local log server.
1600
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001601 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1602 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1603 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1604 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1605
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001606 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1607 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1608 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1609 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1610 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1611
1612 <sample_size>
1613 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1614 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1615 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1616 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1617 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1618
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001619 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001621 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1622 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1623 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1624
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001625 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1626 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1627 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1628 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001629
1630 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001631 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1632 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1633 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1634 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1635 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1636 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001637
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001638 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001639
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001640log-send-hostname [<string>]
1641 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1642 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1643 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1644 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1645 the logs.
1646
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001647log-tag <string>
1648 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1649 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1650 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001651 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001652
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001653lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001654 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1655 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1656 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1657 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1658 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1659 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001660 used multiple times.
1661
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001662lua-load-per-thread <file>
1663 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1664 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1665 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1666 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1667 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1668 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1669 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1670 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1671 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1672 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1673 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1674 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1675 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1676 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1677 times.
1678
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001679lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1680 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1681 variable.
1682 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1683 to "path".
1684
1685 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1686 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1687 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1688 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1689 will be checked earlier.
1690
1691 As an example by specifying the following path:
1692
1693 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1694 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1695
1696 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1697 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1698 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1699 paths if that does not exist either.
1700
1701 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1702 documentation.
1703
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001704master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001705 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1706 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1707 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001708 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001709 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1710 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001711 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1712 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1713 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1714 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1715 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001716
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001717 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001718
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001719mworker-max-reloads <number>
1720 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001721 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001722 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1723 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1724 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1725
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001726nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1728 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1729 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001730 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1731 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001732 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1733 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1734 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001735
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001736nbthread <number>
1737 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001738 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001739 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1740 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1741 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1742 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001743 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1744 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1745 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1746 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1747 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1748 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1749 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001750
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001751numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001752 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001753 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1754 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1755 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1756 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1757 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1758 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1759 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1760 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1761
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001762pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001763 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1764 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1765 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1766 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001767
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001768pp2-never-send-local
1769 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1770 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1771 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1772 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1773 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1774 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1775 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1776 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1777 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1778 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1779 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1780
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001781presetenv <name> <value>
1782 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1783 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1784 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1785 and "unsetenv".
1786
1787resetenv [<name> ...]
1788 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1789 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1790 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1791 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1792 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1793 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1794 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1795 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1796
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001797stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001798 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1799 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1800 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1801 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1802 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1803 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001804 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001805 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1806 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1807 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1808 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001809
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001810server-state-base <directory>
1811 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001812 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1813 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001814
1815server-state-file <file>
1816 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1817 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1818 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1819 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1820 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1821 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1822 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1823 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001824 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1825 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001826
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001827set-dumpable
1828 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1829 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1830 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1831 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1832 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1833 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1834 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1835 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1836 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1837 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1838 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1839 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1840 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1841 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1842 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1843 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1844 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1845 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1846
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001847set-var <var-name> <expr>
1848 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1849 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1850 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1851 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1852 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1853 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1854 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1855 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1856 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1857
1858 Example:
1859 global
1860 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1861 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1862 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1863
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001864setenv <name> <value>
1865 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1866 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1867 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1868 and "unsetenv".
1869
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001870ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1872 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001873 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001874 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001875 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1876 information and recommendations see e.g.
1877 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1878 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1879 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1880 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001881
1882ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1884 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
William Lallemanda088aa02024-02-29 18:04:12 +01001885 describing the list of cipher algorithms in "cipher suite" format that are
1886 negotiated during the TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which do not
1887 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in "man 1
1888 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For cipher
1889 configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier using the "OpenSSL" ciphers format,
1890 please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind"
1891 keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001892
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001893ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1895 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1896 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1897 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1898 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1899
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001900ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1902 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1903 keyword to see available options.
1904
1905 Example:
1906 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001907 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001908
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001909ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1911 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001912 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001913 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001914 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1915 information and recommendations see e.g.
1916 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1917 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1918 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1919 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1920 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001921
1922ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
William Lallemanda088aa02024-02-29 18:04:12 +01001924 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1925 describing the list of cipher algorithms in "cipher suite" format that are
1926 negotiated during the TLS handshake with the server, for all "server" lines
1927 which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001928 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
William Lallemanda088aa02024-02-29 18:04:12 +01001929 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier using the "OpenSSL" cipher
1930 format, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the
1931 "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001932
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001933ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1935 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1936 keyword to see available options.
1937
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001938ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1940 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1941 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001942 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001943 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001944 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1945 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1946 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1947 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001948 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1949 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1950 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1951
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001952ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1953 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1954 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001955 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001956 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001957 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1958
1959 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001960
1961 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1962 and won't try to remove them.
1963
1964 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1965
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001966ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001967 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001968 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1969 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1970 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001971
1972 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1973 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1974 optimize the startup time.
1975
1976 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1977 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1978 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1979
1980 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001981 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001982
1983 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001984 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1985 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001986
1987 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1988 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1989 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1990 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1991 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001992 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001993
1994 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001995 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001996 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1997 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1998 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1999 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2000 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002001 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002002
2003 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2004
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002005 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002006 a cert bundle.
2007
2008 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2009 separately in several "crt".
2010
2011 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2012 since files are loading separately.
2013
2014 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2015 required to commit them.
2016
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002017 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002018 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002019
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002020 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2021 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2022 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002023
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002024 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2025 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2026 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002027
2028 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002029 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2030 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002031
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002032 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2033 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2034
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002035 The default behavior is "all".
2036
2037 Example:
2038 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2039 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2040 ssl-load-extra-files none
2041
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002042 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2043 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002044
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002045ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2046 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2047 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2048 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2049
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002050ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002051 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002052 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2053 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2054 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2055 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2056 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2057 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002058 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002059
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002060stats maxconn <connections>
2061 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2062 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2063
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002064stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2065 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2066 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2067 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002068 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002069 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002070
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002071 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2072 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2073 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002074
2075stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2076 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2077 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002078 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002079
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002080strict-limits
2081 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2082 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2083 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2084 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2085 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002086
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002087uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002088 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002089 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2090 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2091 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2092
2093ulimit-n <number>
2094 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2095 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2096 option.
2097
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002098unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2099 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2100
2101 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2102 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2103 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2104 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2105 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002106 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002107 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2108 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2109 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2110 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2111
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002112unsetenv [<name> ...]
2113 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2114 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2115 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2116 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2117 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2118 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2119 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002121user <user name>
2122 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2123 See also "uid" and "group".
2124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002125node <name>
2126 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2127
2128 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2129 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2130 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2131 traffic.
2132
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002133wurfl-cache-size <size>
2134 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2135 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2136 - "0" : no cache is used.
2137 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002138
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002139 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2140 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002141
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002142wurfl-data-file <file path>
2143 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2144 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002146 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002147 with USE_WURFL=1.
2148
2149wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2150 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2151 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2152 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2153
2154 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2155
2156 Valid WURFL properties are:
2157 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2158
2159 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2160 device.
2161
2162 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2163 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2164
2165 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2166 particular web request.
2167
2168 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2169 used Libwurfl API version.
2170
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002171 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2172 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2173
2174 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2175 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2176
2177 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2178
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002179 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002180 with USE_WURFL=1.
2181
2182wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2183 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2184 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2185
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002186 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002187 with USE_WURFL=1.
2188
2189wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2190 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2191 thus before the chroot.
2192
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002193 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002194 with USE_WURFL=1.
2195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021963.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002197-----------------------
2198
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002199busy-polling
2200 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2201 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2202 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2203 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2204 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2205 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2206 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2207 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2208 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2209 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2210 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2211 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2212 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2213 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2214 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2215 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2216 "poll" pollers.
2217
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002218 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2219 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2220 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2221
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002222max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002223 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002224 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2225 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2226 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2227 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2228 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2229 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2230 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2231
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002232maxcompcpuusage <number>
2233 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2234 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2235 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2236 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2237 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2238 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2239 and from introducing high latencies.
2240
2241maxcomprate <number>
2242 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2243 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2244 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2245 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2246 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2247 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2248 default value.
2249
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002250maxconn <number>
2251 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2252 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2253 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002254 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2255 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2256 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2257 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002258 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2259 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2260 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2261 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2262 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2263 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002264
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002265maxconnrate <number>
2266 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2267 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2268 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2269 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2270 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2271 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2272 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2273 fairness.
2274
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002275maxpipes <number>
2276 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2277 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2278 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2279 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2280 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2281 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2282
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002283maxsessrate <number>
2284 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2285 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2286 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2287 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2288 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2289 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2290 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2291 fairness.
2292
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002293maxsslconn <number>
2294 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2295 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2296 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2297 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2298 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2299 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2300 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002301 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2302 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2303 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2304 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002305 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002306 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2307 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002308
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002309maxsslrate <number>
2310 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2311 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2312 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2313 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2314 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2315 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2316 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2317 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2318 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2319 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2320
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002321maxzlibmem <number>
2322 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2323 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2324 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002325 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2326 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2327 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2328
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002329no-memory-trimming
2330 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2331 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2332 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2333 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2334 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2335 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2336 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2337 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2338 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2339 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2340 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2341 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2342 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2343 not suffer from such a problem.
2344
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002345noepoll
2346 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2347 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002348 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002349
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002350noevports
2351 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2352 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2353 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2354 also "nopoll".
2355
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002356nogetaddrinfo
2357 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2358 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2359
2360nokqueue
2361 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2362 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2363 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2364
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002365nopoll
2366 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2367 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002369 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2370 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002371
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002372noreuseport
2373 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2374 command line argument "-dR".
2375
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002376nosplice
2377 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002379 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002380 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002381 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2382 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2383 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2384 "option splice-response".
2385
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002386profiling.memory { on | off }
2387 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2388 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2389 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2390 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2391 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2392 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2393 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2394 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2395 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2396
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002397profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2398 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2399 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2400 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2401 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002402 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002403 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2404 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2405 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2406 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2407
2408 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2409 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2410 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2411 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2412 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002413 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2414 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2415 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2416 CLI.
2417
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002418spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002419 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2420 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2421 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2422 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2423 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2424 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002425
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002426ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002427 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002428 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002429 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002430 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002431 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2432 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2433 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002434 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2435 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002436 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2437 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2438 openssl configuration file uses:
2439 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2440
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002441ssl-mode-async
2442 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002443 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002444 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2445 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002446 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002447 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002448 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002449
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002450tune.buffers.limit <number>
2451 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2452 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2453 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2454 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2455 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002456 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002457 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2458 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2459 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2460 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2461 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2462 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2463 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2464 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002465 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002466
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002467tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2468 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2469 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2470 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002471 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002472
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002473tune.bufsize <number>
2474 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2475 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2476 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2477 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2478 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2479 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2480 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002481 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2482 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002483 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002484 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002485 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002486 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2487 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002488
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002489tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2490 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002491
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002492tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2493 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2494 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2495 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2496 this value. The default value is 1.
2497
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002498tune.fail-alloc
2499 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2500 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2501 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2502 gracefully.
2503
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002504tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2505 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2506 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2507 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2508 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2509 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2510
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002511tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2512 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2513 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2514 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2515 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2516 change it.
2517
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002518tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2519 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002520 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002521 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002522 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2523 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2524 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2525 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2526 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2527
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002528tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2529 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2530 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2531 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2532 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2533 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002534 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002535 recommended not to change this value.
2536
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002537tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002538 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002539 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002540 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002541 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2542 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2543 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2544 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2545
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002546tune.http.cookielen <number>
2547 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2548 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2549 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2550 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2551 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2552 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2553 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2554 to change this value.
2555
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002556tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002557 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2558 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002559 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002560 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002561 configuration directives too.
2562 The default value is 1024.
2563
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002564tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2565 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2566 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2567 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2568 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2569 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2570 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002571 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2572 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2573 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002574
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002575tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2576 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2577 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2578 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2579 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2580 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2581 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002582 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2583 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2584 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2585 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2586 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002587
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002588tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002589 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002590 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2591 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2592 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2593 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002594 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002595 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002596 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002597 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2598
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002599tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2600 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2601 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2602 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2603 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2604 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2605 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2606 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2607 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2608 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2609
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002610tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2611 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002612 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002613 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2614 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002615 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002616 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2617 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2618
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002619tune.lua.maxmem
2620 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2621 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2622 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2623 memory.
2624
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002625tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2626 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002627 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2628 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002629 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002630
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002631tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2632 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2633 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2634 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002635 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002636
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002637tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2638 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2639 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2640 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2641 check servers.
2642
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002643tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002644 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2645 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002646 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2647 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2648 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2649 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2650 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2651 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2652 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2653 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2654 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002655
2656tune.maxpollevents <number>
2657 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2658 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2659 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2660 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2661 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2662
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002663tune.maxrewrite <number>
2664 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2665 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2666 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2667 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2668 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2669 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2670 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2671 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2672 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2673 bufsize.
2674
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002675tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2676 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2677 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2678 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2679 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2680 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2681 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2682 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2683 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2684 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002685 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2686 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002687 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2688 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2689 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2690 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2691 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2692 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2693 setting this parameter to 0.
2694
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002695tune.pipesize <number>
2696 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2697 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2698 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2699 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2700 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2701 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2702
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002703tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2704 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002705 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002706 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2707 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2708 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2709 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002710 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002711
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002712tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2713 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002714 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002715 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2716 default is 20.
2717
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002718tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2719tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2720 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2721 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2722 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002723 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002724 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002725 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2726 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2727
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002728tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002729 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002730 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2731 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2732 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2733 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2734
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002735tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002736 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002737 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2738 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2739 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2740 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2741 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2742 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2743 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002744
2745tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2746 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002747 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002748 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2749 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2750 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2751 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2752 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2753 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2754 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002755
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002756tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2757tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2758 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2759 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2760 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002761 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002762 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002763 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2764 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2765 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2766 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002767 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002768
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002769tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002770 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002771 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2772 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2773 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2774 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2775 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2776 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2777 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2778 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2779 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2780 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2781 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002782
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002783tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2784 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2785 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2786 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2787 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2788
2789tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2790 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2791 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2792 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2793 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2794 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2795 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2796 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2797 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2798 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2799 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2800 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2801 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2802
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002803tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002804 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002805 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2806 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2807 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2808 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2809 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2810
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002811tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2812 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2813 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2814 performances. This is disabled by default.
2815
2816 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2817 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2818
2819 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2820
2821 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2822
2823 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2824
2825 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2826 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2827 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2828
2829 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2830 converted.
2831
2832 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2833 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2834 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2835 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2836 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2837 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2838 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002839 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2840 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002841
2842 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2843
2844 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2845 only need this line:
2846
2847 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2848
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002849tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2850 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002851 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002852 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2853 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2854 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2855 being used for too long.
2856
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002857tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2858 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2859 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2860 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2861 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2862 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2863 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2864 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2865 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2866 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2867 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002868 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002869 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002870
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002871tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2872 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2873 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2874 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2875 1000 entries.
2876
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002877tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002878tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002879tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2880tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2881tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002882 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2883 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2884 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2885 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2886 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2887 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2888 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2889 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002890
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002891 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2892 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2893 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2894 all available space is consumed.
2895 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2896 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2897 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002898
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002899tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2900 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002901 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002902 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002903 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002904 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2905
2906tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2907 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2908 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002909 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2910 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029123.3. Debugging
2913--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002915quiet
2916 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2917 line argument "-q".
2918
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002919zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002920 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002921 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2922 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2923 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2924 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2925 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2926
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029283.4. Userlists
2929--------------
2930It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2931http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2932it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2933
2934userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002935 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002936 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2937
2938group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002939 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002940 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2941 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002943user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2944 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002945 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2946 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002947 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2948 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2949 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2950 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002952 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2953 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2954 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2955 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2956 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2957 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2958 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002959 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002960 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002961
2962 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002963 userlist L1
2964 group G1 users tiger,scott
2965 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002966
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002967 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2968 user scott insecure-password elgato
2969 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002971 userlist L2
2972 group G1
2973 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002974
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002975 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2976 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2977 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002978
2979 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002980
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
29823.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002983----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002984It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002985several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002986instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2987values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2988automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2989In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2990using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2991tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2992reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2993Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2994that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2995each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002996
2997peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002998 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002999 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3000
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003001bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3002bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003003 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3004 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3005
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003006disabled
3007 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3008 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3009 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3010
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003011default-bind [param*]
3012 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3013
3014default-server [param*]
3015 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3016
3017 Arguments:
3018 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3019 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003020 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3021 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3022 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3023 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003024
3025 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3026
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003027enabled
3028 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3029 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003030
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003031log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003032 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3033 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3034 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3035 more details.
3036
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003037peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3038peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003039 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3040 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003041 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003042 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3043 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3044 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003045 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003046
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003047 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003048 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3049
3050 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003051 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3052 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3053 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003054
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003055 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3056 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003057
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003058 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3059 "server" keyword explanation below).
3060
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003061server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3062server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003063 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003064 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003065 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3066 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3067 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003068
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003069 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3070 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3071 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3072 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3073 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003074
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003075 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003076 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003077 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003078 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3079 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3080 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003081
3082 backend mybackend
3083 mode tcp
3084 balance roundrobin
3085 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3086 stick on src
3087
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003088 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3089 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003090
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003091 Example:
3092 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003093 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3094 default-server ssl verify none
3095 server haproxy1 #local peer
3096 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3097 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003098
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003099
3100table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3101 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3102
3103 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3104 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003105 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003106 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3107 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3108 "stick-table" keyword).
3109
3110 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3111 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3112 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3113 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3114 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3115 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3116 of the stick-table name as follows:
3117
3118 peers mypeers
3119 peer A ...
3120 peer B ...
3121 table t1 ...
3122
3123 frontend fe1
3124 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3125
3126 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3127 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3128
3129 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3130 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3131 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3132 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3133 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3134 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3135 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3136
3137 peers mypeers
3138 peer A ...
3139 peer B ...
3140 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3141
3142 backend t1
3143 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3144
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003145 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003146 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3147 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3148
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031493.6. Mailers
3150------------
3151It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3152If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3153in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3154
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003155mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003156 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3157 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3158
3159mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3160 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3161
3162 Example:
3163 mailers mymailers
3164 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3165 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3166
3167 backend mybackend
3168 mode tcp
3169 balance roundrobin
3170
3171 email-alert mailers mymailers
3172 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3173 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3174
3175 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3176 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3177
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003178timeout mail <time>
3179 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3180 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3181 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3182 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3183
3184 Example:
3185 mailers mymailers
3186 timeout mail 20s
3187 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003188
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031893.7. Programs
3190-------------
3191In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3192master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3193managed the same way as the workers.
3194
3195During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3196sequence as a worker:
3197
3198 - the master is re-executed
3199 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3200 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3201 instance of the program
3202
3203During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3204
3205program <name>
3206 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3207 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3208 the management guide).
3209
3210command <command> [arguments*]
3211 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3212 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3213 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3214 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3215
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003216user <user name>
3217 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3218 See also "group".
3219
3220group <group name>
3221 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3222 See also "user".
3223
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003224option start-on-reload
3225no option start-on-reload
3226 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3227 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3228 program section.
3229
3230
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032313.8. HTTP-errors
3232----------------
3233
3234It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3235imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3236several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3237
3238http-errors <name>
3239 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3240 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3241
3242errorfile <code> <file>
3243 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3244
3245 Arguments :
3246 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003247 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003248 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003249
3250 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3251 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3252 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3253 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3254 before any chroot is performed.
3255
3256 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3257
3258 Example:
3259 http-errors website-1
3260 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3261 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3262 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3263
3264 http-errors website-2
3265 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3266 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3267 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3268
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032693.9. Rings
3270----------
3271
3272It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3273servers or traces.
3274
3275ring <ringname>
3276 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3277
3278description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003279 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003280 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3281
3282format <format>
3283 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3284
3285 Arguments:
3286 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3287 one of the following :
3288
3289 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3290 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3291 designed to be used with a local log server.
3292
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003293 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3294 field is stripped. This is the default.
3295 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3296 rfc3164.
3297
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003298 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3299 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3300 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3301 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3302 is the default.
3303
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003304 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003305 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3306
3307 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3308 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3309
3310 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3311 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3312 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3313 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3314 logger consumes.
3315
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003316 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3317 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3318 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3319 with a local log server.
3320
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003321 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3322 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3323 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3324 used with a local log server.
3325
3326maxlen <length>
3327 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3328 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3329 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3330
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003331server <name> <address> [param*]
3332 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3333 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3334 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3335 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3336 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3337 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3338 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3339 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3340 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003341 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3342 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003343
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003344size <size>
3345 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3346 set to BUFSIZE.
3347
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003348timeout connect <timeout>
3349 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3350
3351 Arguments :
3352 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3353 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3354 as explained at the top of this document.
3355
3356timeout server <timeout>
3357 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3358
3359 Arguments :
3360 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3361 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3362 as explained at the top of this document.
3363
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003364 Example:
3365 global
3366 log ring@myring local7
3367
3368 ring myring
3369 description "My local buffer"
3370 format rfc3164
3371 maxlen 1200
3372 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003373 timeout connect 5s
3374 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003375 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003376
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033773.10. Log forwarding
3378-------------------
3379
3380It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003381HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003382
3383log-forward <name>
3384 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3385
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003386backlog <conns>
3387 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3388 on connections accept.
3389
3390bind <addr> [param*]
3391 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003392 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3393 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3394 syslog protocol over TCP.
3395 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003396 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3397
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003398dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003399 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3400 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3401 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3402 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003403 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003404
3405log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003406log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003407 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3408 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3409 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003410 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003411 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3412 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3413 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003414 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003415
3416 Example:
3417 global
3418 log stderr format iso local7
3419
3420 ring myring
3421 description "My local buffer"
3422 format rfc5424
3423 maxlen 1200
3424 size 32764
3425 timeout connect 5s
3426 timeout server 10s
3427 # syslog tcp server
3428 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3429
3430 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003431 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3432 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003433 # all messages on stderr
3434 log global
3435 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3436 log ring@myring local0
3437 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3438 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3439 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3440 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3441 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003442
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003443maxconn <conns>
3444 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3445 10 is the default.
3446
3447timeout client <timeout>
3448 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034504. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003451----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003453Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003454 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3455 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3456 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3457 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003458
3459A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3460connections.
3461
3462A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3463to forward incoming connections.
3464
3465A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3466parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3467
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003468A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3469ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3470sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3471the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3472explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3473from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3474"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3475for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3476to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3477optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3478are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3479any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3480names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3481that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3482duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3483names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3484
3485Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3486settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3487of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3488profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3489timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3492'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3493case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3494
3495Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3496logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3497proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3498However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3499name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3500
3501Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3502and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003503bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003504protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3505modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3506arbitrary criteria.
3507
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003508In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3509a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003510the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003511
3512 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3513 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3514 between responses and new requests.
3515
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003516 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3517 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3518 client-facing connection remains open.
3519
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003520 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3521 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003522
3523The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3524frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3525following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003526weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003527
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003528 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003529
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003530 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3531 ----+-----+-----+----
3532 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3533 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003534 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3535 ----+-----+-----+----
3536 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003537
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003538It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003539only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3540within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003541as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003542content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003543and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3544possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003546There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003547first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003548processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003549second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003550protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3551is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3552new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003553to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003554process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3555already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3556HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3557evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3558one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3559
3560There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3561performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3562tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3563preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3564analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3565HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3566header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3567mitigate this drawback.
3568
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003569There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003570method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3571set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3572in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3573is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3574to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3575above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3576to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3577"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3578frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3579frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3580as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3581upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3582on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3583the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3584upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3585frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3586remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3589--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003591The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3592limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3593they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3594limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003595marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003596option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003597and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3598with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3599specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003601
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3603------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3604acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605backlog X X X -
3606balance X - X X
3607bind - X X -
3608bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003609capture cookie - X X -
3610capture request header - X X -
3611capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003612clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3613clitcpka-idle X X X -
3614clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003615compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003616cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003617declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003618default-server X - X X
3619default_backend X X X -
3620description - X X X
3621disabled X X X X
3622dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003623email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003624email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003625email-alert mailers X X X X
3626email-alert myhostname X X X X
3627email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628enabled X X X X
3629errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003630errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631errorloc X X X X
3632errorloc302 X X X X
3633-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3634errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003635force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003636filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003637fullconn X - X X
3638grace X X X X
3639hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003640http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003641http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003642http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003644http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003645http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003646http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003647http-check set-var X - X X
3648http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003649http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003651http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003652http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON17e3cd52023-01-12 15:59:27 +01003653http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003655ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003656load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003657log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003658log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003659log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003660log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003661max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON59f36bc2023-11-29 10:13:18 +01003662max-session-srv-conns X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003663maxconn X X X -
3664mode X X X X
3665monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003666monitor-uri X X X -
3667option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3668option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3669option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3670option allbackups (*) X - X X
3671option checkcache (*) X - X X
3672option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3673option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003674option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003675option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3676option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003677-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3678option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003679option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3680option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003681option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003682option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003683option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003684option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003685option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003686option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003687option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3688option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3689option httpchk X - X X
3690option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003691option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003692option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003693option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003694option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003695option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3697option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3698option logasap (*) X X X -
3699option mysql-check X - X X
3700option nolinger (*) X X X X
3701option originalto X X X X
3702option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003703option pgsql-check X - X X
3704option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003706option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707option smtpchk X - X X
3708option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3709option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3710option splice-request (*) X X X X
3711option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01003712option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003713option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3714option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3715-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003716option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003717option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3718option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3719option tcpka X X X X
3720option tcplog X X X X
3721option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003722option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003723external-check command X - X X
3724external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003725persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3726rate-limit sessions X X X -
3727redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003728-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003729retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003730retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003731server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003732server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003733server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003734source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003735srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3736srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3737srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003738stats admin - X X X
3739stats auth X X X X
3740stats enable X X X X
3741stats hide-version X X X X
3742stats http-request - X X X
3743stats realm X X X X
3744stats refresh X X X X
3745stats scope X X X X
3746stats show-desc X X X X
3747stats show-legends X X X X
3748stats show-node X X X X
3749stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003750-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3751stick match - - X X
3752stick on - - X X
3753stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003754stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003755stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003756tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003757tcp-check connect X - X X
3758tcp-check expect X - X X
3759tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003760tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003761tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003762tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003763tcp-check set-var X - X X
3764tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003765tcp-request connection - X X -
3766tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003767tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003768tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003769tcp-response content - - X X
3770tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003771timeout check X - X X
3772timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003773timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003774timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003775timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3776timeout http-request X X X X
3777timeout queue X - X X
3778timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003779timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003780timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003781timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003782transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003783unique-id-format X X X -
3784unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003785use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003786use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003787use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003788------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3789 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3793---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003794
3795This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3796
3797
3798acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3799 Declare or complete an access list.
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 no | yes | yes | yes
3802 Example:
3803 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3804 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3805 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003807 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808
3809
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003810backlog <conns>
3811 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3813 yes | yes | yes | no
3814 Arguments :
3815 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3816 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003817 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003818
3819 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3820 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3821 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3822 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3823 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3824 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3825 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3826 backlog parameter.
3827
3828 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3829 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3830 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3831
3832 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3833
3834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003836balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003837 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | no | yes | yes
3840 Arguments :
3841 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3842 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3843 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3844 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3845
3846 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3847 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3848 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3849 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003850 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003851 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003852 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3853 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3854 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3855 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3856 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3857 it, so that you don't worry.
3858
3859 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3860 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3861 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3862 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3863 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3864 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3865 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3866 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003868 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3869 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3870 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3871 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3872 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3873 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3874 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003875 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3876 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3877 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003878
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003879 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003880 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003881 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3882 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003883 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003884 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3885 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3886 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3887 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3888 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003889 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3890 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3891 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3892 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3893 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3894 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003896 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3897 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3898 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3899 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3900 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3901 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3902 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3903 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003904 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003905 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003906 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3907 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3908 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003909
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003910 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3911 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3912 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3913 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3914 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3915 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3916 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3917 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3918 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3919 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3920 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3921 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003922
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003923 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003924 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3925 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3926 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3927 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3928 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3929 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3930 URIs start with a leading "/".
3931
3932 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3933 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3934 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3935 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3936
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003937 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3938 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3939 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3940 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3941
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003942 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003943 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3944
3945 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003946 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3947 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003948 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3949 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3950 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3951 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003952 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003953 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3954 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003955
3956 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3957 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3958 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3959 server will receive the request.
3960
3961 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3962 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3963 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3964 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3965 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003966 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3967 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3968 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003969
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003970 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3971 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3972 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3973 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3974 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003976 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003977 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3978 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3979 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3980
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003981 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3982 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3983 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3984
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003985 random
3986 random(<draws>)
3987 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003988 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3989 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3990 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3991 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003992 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3993 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3994 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3995 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3996 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3997 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3998 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3999 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4000 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4001 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4002 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4003 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4004 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4005 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4006 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4007 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4008 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4009 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4010 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4011 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004012
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004013 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004014 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004015 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4016 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004017 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004018 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4019 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4020 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004021 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004022 used instead.
4023
4024 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4025 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4026 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004027 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004028
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004029 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4030 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4031 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004033 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004034 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4035 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004036
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004037 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4038 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4039 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004040
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004041 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004042 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004043 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4044 NTLM relies on.
4045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004046 Examples :
4047 balance roundrobin
4048 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004049 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004050 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4051 balance hdr(host)
4052 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004053
4054 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4055 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004057 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004058 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4059 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4060 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004061 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004062
4063 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4064 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4065 defaults to 16 kB.
4066
4067 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4068 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4069
4070 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4071 Round Robin.
4072
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004073 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004074 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4075 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4076 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4077
4078 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4079
4080 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004081 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004082 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4083 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4084 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004085
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004086 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004087
4088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004089bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4090bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004091 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4093 no | yes | yes | no
4094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004095 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4096 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4097 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4098 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004099 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004100 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4101 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4102 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4103 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4104 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4105 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004106 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004107 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4108 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004109 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004110 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4111 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004112 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004113 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4114 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004115 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004116 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4117 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4118 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4119 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4120 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4121 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4122 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004123 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4124 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4125 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004126 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4127 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4128 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4129 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004130 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4131 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4132 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004133
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004134 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4135 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004136 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4137 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4138 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004139 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4140 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4141 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4142 the range.
4143
4144 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4145 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4146 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4147 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4148 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4149 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4150 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004151 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004152 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004153
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004154 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004155 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004156 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4157 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4158 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4159 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4160 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4161 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4162
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004163 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4164 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4165 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4166 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4169 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4170 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4171 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4172 in a frontend.
4173
4174 Example :
4175 listen http_proxy
4176 bind :80,:443
4177 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004178 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004179
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004180 listen http_https_proxy
4181 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004182 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004183
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004184 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4185 bind ipv6@:80
4186 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4187 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4188
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004189 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004190 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004191
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004192 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4193 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4194 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4195 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4196 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4197
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004198 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004199 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004200
4201
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004202bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004203 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4205 yes | yes | yes | yes
4206 Arguments :
4207 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4208 may be used to override a default value.
4209
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004210 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004211 option may be combined with other numbers.
4212
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004213 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004214 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4215 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4216 missing from all processes.
4217
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004218 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004219 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004220 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4221 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4222 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4223 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4224 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004225 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004226
4227 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4228 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4229 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4230 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4231 and 'even' instances.
4232
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004233 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4234 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4235 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4236 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004237
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004238 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4239 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4240
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004241 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4242 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4243 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4244
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004245 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4246 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4247
4248 Example :
4249 listen app_ip1
4250 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004251 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004252
4253 listen app_ip2
4254 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004255 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004256
4257 listen management
4258 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004259 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004260
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004261 listen management
4262 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4263 bind-process 1-4
4264
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004265 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004266
4267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004268capture cookie <name> len <length>
4269 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 no | yes | yes | no
4272 Arguments :
4273 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4274 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4275 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4276 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004277 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
4279 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4280 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4281 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4282 right if it exceeds <length>.
4283
4284 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4285 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4286 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4287 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4288
4289 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4290 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4291 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4292
4293 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4294 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4295 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004296 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4297 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4298 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004299
4300 Example:
4301 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4302
4303 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004304 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004305
4306
4307capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004308 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4310 no | yes | yes | no
4311 Arguments :
4312 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004313 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004314 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4315 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4316 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4317
4318 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4319 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4320 it exceeds <length>.
4321
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004322 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4324 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004325 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4326 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4327 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4328 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004329 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004330 environments to find where the request came from.
4331
4332 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4333 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4334 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4335 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004337 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4338 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4339 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4340 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4341 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004342
4343 Example:
4344 capture request header Host len 15
4345 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004346 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004348 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349 about logging.
4350
4351
4352capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004353 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4355 no | yes | yes | no
4356 Arguments :
4357 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004358 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004359 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4360 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4361 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4362
4363 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4364 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4365 it exceeds <length>.
4366
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004367 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004368 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4369 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4370 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004371 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4372 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4373 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4374 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004375
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004376 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4377 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4378 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4379 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4380 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004381
4382 Example:
4383 capture response header Content-length len 9
4384 capture response header Location len 15
4385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004386 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004387 about logging.
4388
4389
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004390clitcpka-cnt <count>
4391 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4392 the connection on the client side.
4393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4394 yes | yes | yes | no
4395 Arguments :
4396 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4397
4398 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4399 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004400 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4401 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004402
4403 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4404
4405
4406clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4407 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4408 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4409 client side.
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | yes | yes | no
4412 Arguments :
4413 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4414 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4415 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4416 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4417
4418 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4419 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004420 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4421 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004422
4423 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4424
4425
4426clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4427 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4429 yes | yes | yes | no
4430 Arguments :
4431 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4432 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4433 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4434 document.
4435
4436 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4437 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004438 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4439 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004440
4441 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4442
4443
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004444compression algo <algorithm> ...
4445compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004446compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004447 Enable HTTP compression.
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 yes | yes | yes | yes
4450 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004451 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4452 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004453 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004454
4455 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004456 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4457 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4458 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004459
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004460 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004461 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004462
4463 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4464 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4465 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4466 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4467 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004468 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004469
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004470 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4471 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4472 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4473 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4474 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4475 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4476 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004477 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004478
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004479 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004480 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004481 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004482 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004483 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004484 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004485 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004486
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004487 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004488 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4489 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004490 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4491 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004492 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004493 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004494 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4495 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004496 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004497 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4498 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004499
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004500 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004501 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4502 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004503 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004504 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004505 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4506 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4507 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4508 "multipart"
4509 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4510 header
4511 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4512 and later
4513 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4514 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004515 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004516
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004517 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004518
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004519 Examples :
4520 compression algo gzip
4521 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004522
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004523
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004524cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004525 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4526 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004527 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004528 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 yes | no | yes | yes
4531 Arguments :
4532 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4533 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4534 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4535 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4536 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4537 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004538 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004539 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4540 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4541
4542 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004543 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004544 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4545 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4546 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4547 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004548 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4549 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004550 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004551 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4552 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004553
4554 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004555 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004556
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004557 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004558 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004559 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004560 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004561 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4562 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4563 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4564 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4565 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4566 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4567 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004568
4569 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4570 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4571 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4572 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4573 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4574 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4575 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4576 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4577 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004578 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004579 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4580 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4581 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004582
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004583 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4584 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4585 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004586 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4587 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4588 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4589 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004590 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4591 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4592 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004593
4594 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4595 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4596 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4597 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4598 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4599 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4600 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4601 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4602 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4603
4604 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4605 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4606 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4607 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4608 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4609 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4610 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4611 persistence cookie in the cache.
4612 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4613
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004614 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4615 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004616 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004617 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4618 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004619 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004620 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4621 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4622 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4623 they logout.
4624
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004625 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004626 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4627 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4628 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4629
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004630 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004631 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4632 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4633 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4634 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4635 this attribute.
4636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004637 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004638 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004639 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4640 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4641 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4642 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4643 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4644 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004645
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004646 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4647 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4648 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4649 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4650 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4651 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4652 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4653 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004654 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004655 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4656 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4657 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4658 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4659 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4660 the site.
4661
4662 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4663 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4664 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4665 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4666 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4667 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4668 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4669 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4670 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4671 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4672 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4673 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4674 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004675 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004676 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4677 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4678
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004679 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4680 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4681 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4682 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4683 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4684 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4685
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004686 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004687 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4688 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4689 repeated.
4690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004691 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4692 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4693 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4694 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004696 Examples :
4697 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4698 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4699 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004700 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004701
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004702 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004703
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004704
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004705declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4706 Declares a capture slot.
4707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 no | yes | yes | no
4709 Arguments:
4710 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4711
4712 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4713 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4714 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4715 for use in the response.
4716
4717 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004718 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004719 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4720
4721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004722default-server [param*]
4723 Change default options for a server in a backend
4724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4725 yes | no | yes | yes
4726 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004727 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4728 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4729 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4730 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004731
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004732 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004733 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4734
4735 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004736
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004737
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004738default_backend <backend>
4739 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | yes | yes | no
4742 Arguments :
4743 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4744
4745 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4746 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4747 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4748 will catch all undetermined requests.
4749
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004750 Example :
4751
4752 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4753 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4754 default_backend dynamic
4755
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004756 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004758
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004759description <string>
4760 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4762 no | yes | yes | yes
4763 Arguments : string
4764
4765 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4766 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4767 it describes.
4768 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4769
4770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004771disabled
4772 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4774 yes | yes | yes | yes
4775 Arguments : none
4776
4777 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4778 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4779 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4780 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4781 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4782 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4783 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4784
4785 See also : "enabled"
4786
4787
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004788dispatch <address>:<port>
4789 Set a default server address
4790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4791 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004792 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004793
4794 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4795 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4796 during start-up.
4797
4798 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4799 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4800 possible with normal servers.
4801
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004802 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004803 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4804 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4805 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4806 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4807
4808 See also : "server"
4809
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004810
4811dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4812 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4814 yes | no | yes | yes
4815 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4816
4817 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004818 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004819 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4820 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004821 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004822 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004824enabled
4825 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4827 yes | yes | yes | yes
4828 Arguments : none
4829
4830 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4831 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4832
4833 See also : "disabled"
4834
4835
4836errorfile <code> <file>
4837 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 yes | yes | yes | yes
4840 Arguments :
4841 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004842 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004843 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844
4845 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004846 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004847 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004848 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4849 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004850
4851 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4852 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4853 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4854
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004855 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4856
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004857 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4858 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4859 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4860 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4861 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4862 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4863 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4864 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4865 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004867 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4868 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4869 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004870 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004871 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4872
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004873 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004874
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004875 Example :
4876 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004877 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004878 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4879 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004881
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004882errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4883 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4884 section.
4885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4886 yes | yes | yes | yes
4887 Arguments :
4888 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4889
4890 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004891 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004892 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4893 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004894
4895 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4896 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4897 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4898 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4899 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004900 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004901 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4902
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004903 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4904 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004905
4906 Example :
4907 errorfiles generic
4908 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4909
4910
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004911errorloc <code> <url>
4912errorloc302 <code> <url>
4913 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | yes | yes | yes
4916 Arguments :
4917 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004918 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004919 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004920
4921 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4922 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4923 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4924 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004925 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926
4927 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4928 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4929 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4930
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004931 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4932
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4934 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4935 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4936 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004937 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4939 request.
4940
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004941 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004942
4943
4944errorloc303 <code> <url>
4945 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4947 yes | yes | yes | yes
4948 Arguments :
4949 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004950 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004951 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004952
4953 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4954 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4955 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4956 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004957 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004958
4959 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4960 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4961 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4962
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004963 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4964
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004965 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4966 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4967 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4968 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004969 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004970
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004971 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004972
4973
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004974email-alert from <emailaddr>
4975 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004976 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004977 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | yes | yes | yes
4979
4980 Arguments :
4981
4982 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4983
4984 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4985 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4986
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004987 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004988 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4989 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004990
4991
4992email-alert level <level>
4993 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4994 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4996 yes | yes | yes | yes
4997
4998 Arguments :
4999
5000 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5001 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5002 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5003
5004 By default level is alert
5005
5006 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5007 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5008 for the proxy.
5009
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005010 Alerts are sent when :
5011
5012 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5013 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5014 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5015 is notice or lower
5016 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5017 and a health check status update occurs
5018
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005019 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5020 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005021 section 3.6 about mailers.
5022
5023
5024email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5025 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5026 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 yes | yes | yes | yes
5028
5029 Arguments :
5030
5031 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5032
5033 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5034 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5035
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005036 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5037 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005038
5039
5040email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5041 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5042 mailers.
5043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5044 yes | yes | yes | yes
5045
5046 Arguments :
5047
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005048 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005049
5050 By default the systems hostname is used.
5051
5052 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5053 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5054 for the proxy.
5055
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005056 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5057 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005058
5059
5060email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005061 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005062 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5063 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | yes | yes | yes
5065
5066 Arguments :
5067
5068 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5069
5070 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5071 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5072
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005073 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005074 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5075
5076
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005077force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5078 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5079 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005080 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005081
5082 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5083 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5084 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5085 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5086 marked down for maintenance operations.
5087
5088 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5089 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5090 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5091 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5092 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5093 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5094 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5095 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5096 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5097
5098 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5099 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5100 is used.
5101
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005102 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005103 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005104
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005105
5106filter <name> [param*]
5107 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5109 no | yes | yes | yes
5110 Arguments :
5111 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5112 referenced in section 9.
5113
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005114 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005115 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005116 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5117 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005118
5119 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5120 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5121
5122 Example:
5123 listen
5124 bind *:80
5125
5126 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5127 filter compression
5128 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5129
5130 compression algo gzip
5131 compression offload
5132
5133 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5134
5135 See also : section 9.
5136
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005137
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005138fullconn <conns>
5139 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5141 yes | no | yes | yes
5142 Arguments :
5143 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5144 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5145
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005146 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005147 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005148 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005149 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5150 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5151 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5152 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5153 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005154 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005155
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005156 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005157 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005158 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5159 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5160 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005161
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005162 Example :
5163 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5164 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5165 # connections.
5166 backend dynamic
5167 fullconn 10000
5168 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5169 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5170
5171 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5172
5173
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005174grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005175 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005177 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005178 Arguments :
5179 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5180 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5181 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5182
5183 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5184 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005185 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005186 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5187
5188 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5189 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5190 simplify it.
5191
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005192
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005193hash-balance-factor <factor>
5194 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5196 yes | no | no | yes
5197 Arguments :
5198 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5199 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005200 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005201
5202 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5203 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5204 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5205 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5206 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5207 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5208 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5209
5210 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5211 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5212 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5213 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5214 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5215
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005216 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5217 consistent hashing mechanism.
5218
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005219 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5220
5221
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005222hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005223 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5225 yes | no | yes | yes
5226 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005227 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5228 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005229
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005230 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5231 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5232 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5233 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5234 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5235 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5236 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5237 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5238 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5239 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005240
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005241 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5242 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5243 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5244 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5245 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5246 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5247 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5248 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5249 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5250 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5251 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5252 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5253 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005254 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5255 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005256
5257 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5258
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005259 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005260 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5261 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5262 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005263 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5264 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5265 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005266
5267 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5268 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005269 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5270 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5271 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5272 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5273
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005274 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005275 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5276 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5277 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5278 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5279 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5280 parameter.
5281
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005282 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5283 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5284 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5285 used on strings.
5286
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005287 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5288
5289 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5290 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5291 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5292 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5293 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5294 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5295 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5296 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5297 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5298 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5299 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5300 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005301
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005302 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5303 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5304 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005305
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005306 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005307
5308
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005309http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5310 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5311 ones).
5312
5313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5314 no | yes | yes | yes
5315
5316 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5317 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5318 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5319 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5320 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5321 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5322
5323 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5324 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5325 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5326
5327 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5328 below.
5329
5330 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5331 instance.
5332
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005333 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5334 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5335 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5336
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005337 Example:
5338 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5339 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5340 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5341
5342http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5343
5344 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5345 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5346 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5347 example, or to pass some internal information.
5348 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5349 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5350 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5351
5352http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5353
5354 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5355 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5356
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005357http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005358
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005359 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5360 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5361 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5362 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5363 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005364
5365http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5367
5368 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5369
5370 Example:
5371 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5372
5373 # applied to:
5374 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5375
5376 # outputs:
5377 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5378
5379 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5380
5381http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5382 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5383
5384 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5385
5386 Example:
5387 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5388
5389 # applied to:
5390 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5391
5392 # outputs:
5393 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5394
5395http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5396
5397 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5398 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5399 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5400
5401http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5402 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5403
5404 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5405 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5406 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5407 fallback.
5408
5409 Example:
5410 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5411 http-response set-status 431
5412 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5413 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5414
5415http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5416
5417 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5418 inline.
5419
5420 Arguments:
5421 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5422 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5423 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5424 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5425 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5426 (request and response)
5427 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5428 processing
5429 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5430 processing
5431 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5432 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5433 and '_'.
5434
5435 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5436 followed by some converters.
5437
5438 Example:
5439 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5440
5441http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5442
5443 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5444 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5445 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5446 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5447 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005448 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005449 processing.
5450
5451 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5452 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005453 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005454 rules evaluation.
5455
5456http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5457
5458 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5459 details about <var-name>.
5460
5461 Example:
5462 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5463
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005464
5465http-check comment <string>
5466 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5467 it fails.
5468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5469 yes | no | yes | yes
5470
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005471 Arguments :
5472 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5473 rule fails.
5474
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005475 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5476 user-friendly error reporting.
5477
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005478 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005479 "http-check expect".
5480
5481
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005482http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5483 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005484 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005485 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5487 yes | no | yes | yes
5488
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005489 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005490 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5491
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005492 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005493 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005494
5495 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5496 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5497 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5498 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5499
5500 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5501
5502 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5503
5504 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5505
5506 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5507
5508 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5509
5510 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5511 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5512 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5513 is used.
5514
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005515 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5516 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5517 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5518 haproxy -vv.
5519
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005520 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5521
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005522 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5523 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5524 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5525 different ports or with different servers.
5526
5527 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5528 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5529 the port with a "http-check connect".
5530
5531 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5532 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5533 do.
5534
5535 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5536 unset-var or comment rules.
5537
5538 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005539 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5540 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5541 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5542 option httpchk
5543
5544 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005545 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005546 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005547 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005548 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005549 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005550
5551 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5552
5553 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005554
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005556http-check disable-on-404
5557 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005559 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005560 Arguments : none
5561
5562 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5563 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5564 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5565 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5566 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5567 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5568 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5569 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005570 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5571 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005572 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5573 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5574 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005575
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005576 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005577
5578
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005579http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005580 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5581 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5582 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005583 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005585 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005586
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005587 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005588 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5589
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005590 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5591 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5592 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5593 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5594 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5595 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5596 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5597 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5598 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5599 result is always conclusive.
5600
5601 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5602 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5603 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005604 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5605 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005606 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5607 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005608 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5609 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5610 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005611
5612 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5613 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005614 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5615 supported :
5616 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5617 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005618 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5619 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5620 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5621 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5622 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005623
5624 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5625 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005626 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5627 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5628 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5629 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005630 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5631
5632 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5633 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5634 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5635 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5636
5637 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5638 informational message reported in logs if an error
5639 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5640 log-format string.
5641
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005642 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005643 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5644 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005645 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5646 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5647 details on the supported keywords.
5648
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005649 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5650 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5651 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5652 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005653
5654 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5655 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5656 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5657 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5658 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5659
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005660 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5661 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5662 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5663 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5664 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5665 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5666 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005667
5668 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005669 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005670 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5671 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5672 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5673 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5674
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005675 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5676 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005677 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5678 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5679 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5680 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5681 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5682 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5683 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5684 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005685 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5686 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5687 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5688 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5689 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5690 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5691 insensitive on the header names.
5692
5693 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5694 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5695 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5696 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5697 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5698 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005699
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005700 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005701 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005702 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5703 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5704 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5705 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5706 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005707 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005708 trace).
5709
5710 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005711 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005712 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5713 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5714 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5715 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5716 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005717 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005718
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005719 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5720 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5721 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5722 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5723 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5724 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5725
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005726 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005727 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005728 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5729 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5730 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5731 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5732 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5733 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5734
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005735 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5736 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5737 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5738 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5739 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005740
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005741 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5742 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5743
5744 Examples :
5745 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005746 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005747
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005748 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5749 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5750
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005751 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005752 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005753
5754 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005755 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005756
5757 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005758 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005759
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005760 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005761 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005762
5763
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005764http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005765 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5766 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005767 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5768 health checks.
5769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5770 yes | no | yes | yes
5771 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005772 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5773
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005774 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5775 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5776 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5777 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5778 to invent non-standard ones.
5779
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005780 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5781 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5782 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5783 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5784
5785 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5786 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5787 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5788 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005789
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005790 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005791 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005792 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005793 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5794 to add it.
5795
5796 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5797 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5798 to the log-format rules.
5799
5800 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5801 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5802 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005803
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005804 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5805 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5806 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5807 request.
5808
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005809 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5810 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5811 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005812 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5813 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5814 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5815 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005816 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005817
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005818 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005819 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5820 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005821
5822 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5823 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5824 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5825 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5826 configured request authority.
5827
5828 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5829 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005830
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005831 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005832
5833
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005834http-check send-state
5835 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5837 yes | no | yes | yes
5838 Arguments : none
5839
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005840 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005841 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005842 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5843 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5844 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005845
5846 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5847 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5848 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5849 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5850 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005851 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5852 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5853 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5854
5855 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5856 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5857 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5858
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005859 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5860 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5861 checked in multiple backends.
5862
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005863 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005864 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5865
5866 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5867 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5868 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5869 one fails.
5870
5871 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5872 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5873 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5874
5875 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5876 server's queue.
5877
5878 Example of a header received by the application server :
5879 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5880 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5881
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005882 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5883 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005884
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005885
5886http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005887 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5889 yes | no | yes | yes
5890
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005891 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005892 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5893 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5894 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5895 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5896 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5897 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5898 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5899 and '-'.
5900
5901 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5902
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005903 Examples :
5904 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005905
5906
5907http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005908 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 yes | no | yes | yes
5911
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005912 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005913 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5914 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5915 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5916 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5917 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5918 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5919 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5920 and '-'.
5921
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005922 Examples :
5923 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005925
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005926http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5927 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5928 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5929 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5930 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 yes | yes | yes | yes
5933 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005934 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005935 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005936 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005937 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005938
5939 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5940 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5941 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5942 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5943
5944 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5945 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5946 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5947 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5948
5949 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5950 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5951 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5952 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5953 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5954 chroot is performed.
5955
5956 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5957 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5958 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5959 considered.
5960
5961 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5962 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5963 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5964 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5965 considered as a raw string.
5966
5967 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5968 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5969 "content-type".
5970
5971 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5972 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5973 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5974 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5975 evaluated as a log-format string.
5976
5977 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5978 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5979 argument to "content-type".
5980
5981 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5982 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5983 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5984 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5985
5986 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5987 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5988 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5989 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5990 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5991 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5992 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5993 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5994
5995 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5996 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5997 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5998
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005999 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6000 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6001 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6002 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6003 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6004
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006005 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6006 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6007
6008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006010 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6011
6012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 no | yes | yes | yes
6014
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006015 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6016 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6017 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6018 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6019 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6022 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 Example:
6027 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6028 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6029 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006031 http-request allow if nagios
6032 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6033 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6034 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006036 Example:
6037 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6038 acl add path /addacl
6039 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6044 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006046 Example:
6047 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6048 acl setmap path /setmap
6049 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006052
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006053 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6054 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6057 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006059http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6062 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6063 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6064 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6065 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6066 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6067 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6068 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006072 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6073 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6074 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6075 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6076 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6077 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6078 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6079 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006081http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006083 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6084 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006085
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6090 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6091 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6092 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6093 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006094
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006095 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6096 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6097 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6098 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6099 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6100 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6101 instead.
6102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006103 Example:
6104 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6105 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006106
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006107http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006108
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006109 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006111http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6112 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6115 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6116 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6117 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6118 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6119 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6120 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6121 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6122 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6125 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6126 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006127 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6128
6129 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6130 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6131 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6132 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006134http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006136 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6137 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6138 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6139 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6140 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6141 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006142
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006143http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006144
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006145 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6146 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6147 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6148 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6149 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006151http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006153 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6154 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6155 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6156 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6157 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6158 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006159
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006160http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6161http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6162 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6163 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6164 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6165 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006166
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006167 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6168 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6169 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006170 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006171 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6172 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6173 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006174 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006175 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006176
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006177http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6178 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6179 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6180 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6181
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006182http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6183
6184 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6185 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6186 pointed by <resolvers>.
6187 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6188 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6189 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6190 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6191 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6192 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6193 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6194 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6195 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6196 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006197 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6198 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006199
6200 Example:
6201 resolvers mydns
6202 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6203 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6204 timeout retry 1s
6205 hold valid 10s
6206 hold nx 3s
6207 hold other 3s
6208 hold obsolete 0s
6209 accepted_payload_size 8192
6210
6211 frontend fe
6212 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006213 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006214 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6215
6216 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6217 # which mean DNS resolution error
6218 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6219
6220 default_backend be
6221
6222 backend b_503
6223 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6224 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6225 # 503 error page to end users
6226
6227 backend be
6228 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6229 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6230 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6231 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6232 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6233
6234 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6235 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6236
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006237http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6238
6239 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6240 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6241 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6242 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006243 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6244 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006245
6246 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6247
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006248http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006249http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006250http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006251http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006252http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006253http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006254http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006255http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6256http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006257
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006258 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6259
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006260 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006261 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6262 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6263 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6264 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006265
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006266 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6267 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6268 the supported backend.
6269
6270 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6271 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6272 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6273 number of segments in the path.
6274
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006275 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6276 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6277 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6278 when improperly combined.
6279
6280 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6281 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6282 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6283 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6284 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6285
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006286 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006287
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006288 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6289
6290 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6291 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6292
6293 Example:
6294 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6295
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006296 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6297
6298 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6299 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6300
6301 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6302 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6303
6304 Example:
6305 - /#foo -> /
6306
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006307 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6308 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006309
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006310 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6311 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6312
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006313 Example:
6314 - /. -> /
6315 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6316 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6317 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006318
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006319 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6320 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6321
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006322 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006323 their preceding segment.
6324
6325 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6326 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6327
6328 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6329 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006330
6331 Example:
6332 - /foo/../ -> /
6333 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6334 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6335 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006336 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006337 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006338 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006339
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006340 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6341 removed as well:
6342
6343 Example:
6344 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6345 - /bar/../../ -> /
6346
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006347 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6348 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006349
6350 Example:
6351 - // -> /
6352 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6353
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006354 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6355 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6356
6357 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6358 ".", "_", and "~".
6359
6360 Example:
6361 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6362 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6363 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6364 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6365
6366 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6367 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6368
6369 Example:
6370 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6371 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6372
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006373 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006374 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006375
6376 Example:
6377 - /%6f -> /%6F
6378 - /%zz -> /%zz
6379
6380 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6381 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6382
6383 Example:
6384 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6385
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006386 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006387 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6388 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6389
6390 Example:
6391 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6392 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6393 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006395http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006397 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6398 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6399 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6400 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6401 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006403http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006405 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6406 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6407 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6408 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006410http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6411 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006412
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006413 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006414 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6415 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6416 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6417 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6418 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006419
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006420 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6421 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6422 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6423 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6424 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006425
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006426 Example:
6427 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6428
6429 # applied to:
6430 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6431
6432 # outputs:
6433 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6434
6435 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006436
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006437 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6438
6439 # applied to:
6440 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006442 # outputs:
6443 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006444
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006445http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6447
6448 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6449 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006450 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6451 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6452 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006453
6454 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6455 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6456 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6457
6458 Example:
6459 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6460 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6461
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006462 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6463 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6464 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6465 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6466
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006467http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6468 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6469
6470 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6471 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6472 query-string are replaced.
6473
6474 Example:
6475 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6476 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6477
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006478http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6479 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6480
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006481 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6482 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6483 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6484 against.
6485
6486 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6487 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6488 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006489
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006490 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6491 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6492 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6493 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6494 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6495 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6496 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6497 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6498 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006499 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6500 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006501
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006502 Example:
6503 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6504 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006505
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006506 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6507 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006509http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6510 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006511
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006512 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6513 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6514 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6515 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006516
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006517 Example:
6518 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006519
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006520 # applied to:
6521 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006522
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006523 # outputs:
6524 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006525
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006526http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6527 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6528 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006529 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006530 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6531
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006532 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006533 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6534 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006535 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006536 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006537 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006538 are followed to create the response :
6539
6540 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6541 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6542 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6543 ignored.
6544
6545 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6546 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006547 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006548 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6549 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006550
6551 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6552 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6553 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006554 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006555 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006556
6557 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6558 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6559 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006560 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006561 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006562 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006563
6564 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6565 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6566 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6567 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6568 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6569 as a raw content.
6570
6571 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6572 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6573 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6574 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6575 considered as a raw string.
6576
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006577 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006578 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6579 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6580 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6581
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006582 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6583 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006584 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006585
6586 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6587
6588 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006589 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006590 if { path /ping }
6591
6592 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6593 if { path /favicon.ico }
6594
6595 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6596 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6597 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6600http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006602 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6603 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6604 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006605
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006606http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6607 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006608
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006609 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6610 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6611 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6612 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006616 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6617 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6618 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6619 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6620 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006622 Arguments:
6623 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6624 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 Example:
6627 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6628 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6631 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006633http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006635 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6636 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6637 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639 Arguments:
6640 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6641 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643 Example:
6644 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6645 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6648 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6649 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006651http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006653 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6654 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6655 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6656 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6657 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006659 Example:
6660 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6661 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6662 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6663 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6664 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6665 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6666 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6667 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6668 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006672 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6673 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6674 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6675 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6676 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006678http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6682 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6683 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6684 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6685 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6686 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6687 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6688 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6689 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6694 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6695 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6696 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6697 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6698 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6699 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006701http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006703 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6704 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6705 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006707http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006709 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6710 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6711 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6712 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6713 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6714 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6715 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6716 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006718http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6721 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6722 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6723 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6724 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6725 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727 Example :
6728 # prepend the host name before the path
6729 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006730
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006731http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6732
6733 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6734 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6735 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006737http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006739 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6740 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6741 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6742 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6743 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006745http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006747 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6748 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6749 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6750 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6751 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6752 values have higher priority.
6753 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6754 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6755 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6756 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6757 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006759http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006761 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6762 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6763 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6764 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6765 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6766 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6767 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006770
6771 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006772 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6773 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006775http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6776 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6777 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6778 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006779 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6780 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006781
6782 Arguments :
6783 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6784 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006785
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006786 See also "option forwardfor".
6787
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006788 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006789 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6790 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6791
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006792 # After the masking this will track connections
6793 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6794 http-request track-sc0 src
6795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006796 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6797 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6798
6799http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6800
6801 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6802 expression.
6803
6804 Arguments:
6805 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6806 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006807
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006808 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006809 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6810 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6811
6812 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6813 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6814 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6815
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006816http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006817 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6818
6819 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6820 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6821 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6822 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6823 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6824
6825 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6826 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6827 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6828 results.
6829
6830 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006831 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6832 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006834http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6835
6836 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6837 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6838 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6839 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6840 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6841 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6842 information from the request.
6843
6844 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6845
6846http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6847
6848 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6849 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulete6794272022-11-22 15:41:48 +01006850 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
6851 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
6852 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
6853 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
6854 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006855 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6856
6857http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6858
6859 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6860 inline.
6861
6862 Arguments:
6863 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6864 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6865 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6866 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6867 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6868 (request and response)
6869 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6870 processing
6871 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6872 processing
6873 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6874 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6875 and '_'.
6876
6877 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6878 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006879
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006880 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006881 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006882
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006883http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6884 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006885
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006886 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6887 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6888 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6889 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6890 agent name must be used.
6891
6892 Arguments:
6893 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6894
6895 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6896 configuration.
6897
6898http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6899
6900 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6901 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6902 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6903 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6904 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6905 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6906 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6907 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6908 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6909 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6910 action.
6911 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6912 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6913 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6914 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6915 you fully understand how it works.
6916
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006917http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6918
6919 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6920 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6921 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6922 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6923 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006924 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006925 processing.
6926
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006927 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006928 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6929 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6930 rules evaluation.
6931
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006932http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6933http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6934 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6935 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6936 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6937 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006938
6939 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6940 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6941 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006942 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6943 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6944 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6945 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6946 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6947 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006948 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006949 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6950 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6951 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006952 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006953 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6954 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6955 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6956 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6957 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006958
6959http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6960http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6961http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6962
6963 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6964 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6965 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6966 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006967 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006968 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6969 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6970 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6971 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6972 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6973 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6974 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6975
6976 Arguments :
6977 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6978 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6979 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6980 select which table entry to update the counters.
6981
6982 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6983 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6984 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6985 that table until the session ends.
6986
6987 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6988 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6989 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6990 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6991 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6992 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6993 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6994 useful information.
6995
6996 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6997 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6998 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6999 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7000 checks that make use of it.
7001
7002http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7003
7004 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007005
7006 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007007 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007008
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007009http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7010
7011 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7012 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7013 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7014 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7015 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7016 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7017
7018 Arguments :
7019 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7020
7021 Example:
7022 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7023
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007024http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7025 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7026
Thayne McCombs25d2d8a2024-01-28 22:07:32 -07007027 This will delay the processing of the request or response until one of the
7028 following conditions occurs:
7029 - The full request body is received, in which case processing proceeds
7030 normally.
7031 - <bytes> bytes have been received, when the "at-least" argument is given and
7032 <bytes> is non-zero, in which case processing proceeds normally.
7033 - The request buffer is full, in which case processing proceeds normally. The
7034 size of this buffer is determined by the "tune.bufsize" option.
7035 - The request has been waiting for more than <time> milliseconds. In this
7036 case HAProxy will respond with a 408 "Request Timeout" error to the client
7037 and stop processing the request. Note that if any of the other conditions
7038 happens first, this timeout will not occur even if the full body has
7039 not yet been recieved.
7040
7041 This action may be used as a replacement for "option http-buffer-request".
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007042
7043 Arguments :
7044
7045 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7046 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7047
7048 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007049 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Thayne McCombs25d2d8a2024-01-28 22:07:32 -07007050 bytes. A value of 0 (the default) means no limit.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007051
7052 Example:
7053 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7054
7055 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007057http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007059 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7060 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7061 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007062
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007064http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007065 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7066
7067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7068 no | yes | yes | yes
7069
7070 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7071 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7072 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7073 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7074 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7075 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7078 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082 Example:
7083 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7088 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007090 Example:
7091 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007093 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007095 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7096 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007098 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7099 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007101http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7104 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7105 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7106 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7107 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7108 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7109 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7110 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007112http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007114 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7115 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7116 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7117 example, or to pass some internal information.
7118 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7119 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7120 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007122http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007124 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7125 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007126
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007127http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007128
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007129 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007131http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007133 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7134 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7135 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7136 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7137 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7138 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7139 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007141 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7142 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7143 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7144 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7145 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007146
7147 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7148 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7149 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7150 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007152http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007154 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7155 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7156 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7157 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7158 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7159 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007160
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007161http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007162
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007163 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7164 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7165 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7166 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7167 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007169http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007170
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007171 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7172 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7173 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7174 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7175 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7176 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007177
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007178http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7179http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7180 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7181 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7182 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7183 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007184
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007185 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7186 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7187 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007188 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007189 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7190 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7191 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007192 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007193 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007195http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007197 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7198 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7199 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7200 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7201 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7202 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007204http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7205 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007206
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007207 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7208 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007210 Example:
7211 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007213 # applied to:
7214 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007216 # outputs:
7217 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007219 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007220
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007221http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7222 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007223
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007224 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007225 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007227 Example:
7228 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007229
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007230 # applied to:
7231 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007232
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007233 # outputs:
7234 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007235
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007236http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7237 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7238 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007239 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007240 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7241
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007242 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007243 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7244 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007245 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007246 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007247 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007248 are followed to create the response :
7249
7250 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7251 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7252 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7253 ignored.
7254
7255 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7256 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007257 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007258 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7259 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007260
7261 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7262 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7263 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007264 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007265 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007266
7267 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7268 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7269 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007270 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007271 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007272 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007273
7274 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7275 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7276 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7277 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7278 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7279 as a raw content.
7280
7281 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7282 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7283 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7284 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7285 considered as a raw string.
7286
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007287 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7288 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7289 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7290 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7291
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007292 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7293 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007294 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007295
7296 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7297
7298 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007299 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007300 if { status eq 404 }
7301
7302 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7303 string "This is the end !" \
7304 if { status eq 500 }
7305
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007306http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7307http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007308
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007309 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7310 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7311 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007312
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007313http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7314 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007315
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007316 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7317 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7318 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7319 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007320
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007321http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7322 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007324 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7325 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7326 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7327 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7328 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007329
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007330 Arguments:
7331 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007333 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7334 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007335
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007336http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007337
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007338 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7339 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7340 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007341
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007342http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7343
7344 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7345 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7346 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7347 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7348 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7349
7350http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7351
7352 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7353 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7354 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7355 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7356 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7357 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7358 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7359 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7360 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7361
7362http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7363
7364 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7365 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7366 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7367 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7368 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7369 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7370 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7371
7372http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7373
7374 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7375 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7376 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7377 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7378 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7379 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7380 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7381 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7382
7383http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7385
7386 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7387 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7388 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7389 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007390
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007391 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007392 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7393 http-response set-status 431
7394 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7395 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007396
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007397http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007398
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007399 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7400 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7401 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7402 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7403 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7404 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7405 based on some information from the request.
7406
7407 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7408
7409http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7410
7411 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7412 inline.
7413
7414 Arguments:
7415 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7416 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7417 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7418 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7419 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7420 (request and response)
7421 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7422 processing
7423 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7424 processing
7425 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7426 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7427 and '_'.
7428
7429 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7430 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007431
7432 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007433 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007435http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007436
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007437 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7438 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7439 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7440 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7441 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7442 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7443 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7444 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7445 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7446 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7447 action.
7448 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7449 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7450 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7451 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7452 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007453
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007454http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7455
7456 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7457 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7458 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7459 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7460 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007461 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007462 processing.
7463
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007464 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007465 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007466 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007467 rules evaluation.
7468
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007469http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7470http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7471http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007472
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007473 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7474 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7475 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7476 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7477 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007478 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007479
7480http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7481
7482 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7483 about <var-name>.
7484
7485 Example:
7486 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7487
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007488http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7489 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7490
7491 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7492 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7493 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7494 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7495 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7496 buffer is full.
7497
7498 Arguments :
7499
7500 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7501 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7502
7503 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007504 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007505 bytes.
7506
7507 Example:
7508 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007509
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007510http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7511 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7512
7513 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7514 yes | no | yes | yes
7515
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007516 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007517 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7518 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7519 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007520
7521 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7522
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007523 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7524 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7525 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7526 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7527 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7528 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7529 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007530 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007531 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7532 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007533
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007534 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7535 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7536 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7537 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7538 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7539 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7540 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007541 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7542 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7543 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7544 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7545 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7546 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007547
7548 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7549 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7550 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7551 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7552 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7553 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7554 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7555 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007556 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007557 downsides of rare connection failures.
7558
7559 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7560 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7561 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7562 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7563 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7564 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007565 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007566 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7567 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7568 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7569 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7570 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7571
7572 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007573 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7574 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7575 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7576 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007577
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007578 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7579 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007580
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007581 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007582
7583 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7584 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7585 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7586
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007587 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7588 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7589 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7590 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7591 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7592 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7593 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7594 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7595 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7596 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7597 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7598
7599 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7600 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7601 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7602 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7603 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7604
7605 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7606 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007607
7608
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007609http-send-name-header [<header>]
7610 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7612 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007613 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007614 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7615
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007616 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7617 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7618 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7619 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7620 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7621 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7622 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7623 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7624 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7625 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7626 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7627 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7628 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7629 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7630 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7631 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007632
7633 See also : "server"
7634
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007635id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007636 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7638 no | yes | yes | yes
7639 Arguments : none
7640
7641 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7642 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7643 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007644
7645
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007646ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7647 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7648 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007649 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007650
7651 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7652 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7653 and running).
7654
7655 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7656 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7657 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007658 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007659 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7660
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007661 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7662 "unless" condition is met.
7663
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007664 Example:
7665 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7666 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7667 ignore-persist if url_static
7668
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007669 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7670
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007671load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7672 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7673 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7674 yes | no | yes | yes
7675
7676 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7677 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7678 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007679 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007680 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007681 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7682 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7683 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7684
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007685 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007686 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007687 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007688
7689 Arguments:
7690 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7691 named "server-state-file".
7692
7693 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7694 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7695 name is used as a file name.
7696
7697 none don't load any stat for this backend
7698
7699 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007700 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7701 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7702 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007703 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007704 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007705
7706 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7707 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7708
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007709 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007710
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007711 global
7712 stats socket /tmp/socket
7713 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007714
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007715 defaults
7716 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007717
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007718 backend bk
7719 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7720 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007721
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007722
7723 Then one can run :
7724
7725 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7726
7727 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7728
7729 1
7730 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7731 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7732 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7733
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007734 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007735
7736 global
7737 stats socket /tmp/socket
7738 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7739
7740 defaults
7741 load-server-state-from-file local
7742
7743 backend bk
7744 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7745 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7746
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007747
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007748 Then one can run :
7749
7750 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7751
7752 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7753
7754 1
7755 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7756 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7757 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7758
7759 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7760 "show servers state"
7761
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007762
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007763log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007764log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007765 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007766no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007767 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7769 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007770
7771 Prefix :
7772 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7773 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7774 prefix does not allow arguments.
7775
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007776 Arguments :
7777 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7778 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7779 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7780 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7781 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7782 parameter.
7783
7784 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7785 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7786
7787 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7788 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7789 standard syslog port).
7790
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007791 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7792 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7793 standard syslog port).
7794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007795 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7796 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7797 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007798 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007799
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007800 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7801 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7802 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7803 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7804 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7805 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7806 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7807 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7808 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7809 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7810 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7811 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007812 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007813 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7814 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7815 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007816 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7817 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007818
7819 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7820 and "fd@2", see above.
7821
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007822 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7823 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7824 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7825 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7826 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7827 having the logs instantly available.
7828
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007829 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7830 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7831 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7832
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007833 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7834 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007835
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007836 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7837 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7838 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7839 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7840 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7841 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7842 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7843 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7844 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7845 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007846 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007847
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007848 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7849 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7850 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7851 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7852 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7853
7854 <sample_size>
7855 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7856 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7857 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7858 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7859 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7860
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007861 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7862 one of the following :
7863
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007864 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7865 field is stripped. This is the default.
7866 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7867 rfc3164.
7868
7869 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007870 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7871
7872 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7873 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7874
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007875 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7876 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7877 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7878 designed to be used with a local log server.
7879
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007880 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7881 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7882 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7883 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7884 systemd logger consumes.
7885
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007886 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7887 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7888 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7889 used with a local log server.
7890
7891 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7892 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7893 designed to be used with a local log server.
7894
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007895 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7896 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7897 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7898 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7899
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007900 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7901
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007902 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7903 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7904 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7905
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007906 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7907 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7908 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7909 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007910
7911 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7912 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7913 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007914 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7915 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7916 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7917 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7918 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007919
7920 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7921
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007922 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7923 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7924 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007925
7926 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7927 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7928 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7929 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7930
7931 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7932 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007933
7934 Example :
7935 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007936 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7937 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7938 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007939 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007940 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7941 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007942 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007943
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007944
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007945log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007946 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7948 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007949
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007950 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7951 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7952 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7953 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7954 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007955
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007956 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7957 "option httplog" directives.
7958
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007959log-format-sd <string>
7960 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7961 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 yes | yes | yes | no
7963
7964 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7965 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7966 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7967 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7968 which covers the log format string in depth.
7969
7970 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7971 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7972
7973 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7974 log format to "rfc5424".
7975
7976 Example :
7977 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7978
7979
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007980log-tag <string>
7981 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7983 yes | yes | yes | yes
7984
7985 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7986 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007987 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007988 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7989 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7990 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7991 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7992 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7993 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007994
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007995max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7996 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7998 yes | no | yes | yes
7999
8000 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8001 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8002 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8003 servers.
8004
8005 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008006 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008007 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8008 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8009 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008010 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008011 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8012 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8013 picking a different server.
8014
8015 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8016 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8017 even if they have to be queued.
8018
8019 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8020 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8021
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008022max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8023 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8024 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8025 defined at build time).
Aurelien DARRAGON85f953c2023-11-20 17:53:36 +01008026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8027 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008028
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008029maxconn <conns>
8030 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8032 yes | yes | yes | no
8033 Arguments :
8034 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8035 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8036 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8037 closes.
8038
8039 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008040 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008041 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8042 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008043 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8044 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8045 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8046 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008047
8048 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8049 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8050 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8051
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008052 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8053 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008054
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008055 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8056
8057
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008058mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008059 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8061 yes | yes | yes | yes
8062 Arguments :
8063 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8064 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8065 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8066 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8067
8068 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8069 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8070 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8071 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8072 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8073
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008074 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8075 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8076 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008077
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008078 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008079 defaults http_instances
8080 mode http
8081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008082
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008083monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008084 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8086 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008087 Arguments :
8088 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8089 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008090 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008091 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8092 backend and its backup.
8093
8094 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8095 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8096 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8097 servers in a list of backends.
8098
8099 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8100 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8101 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008102 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008103 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8104 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008105 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008106 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8107 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008108
8109 Example:
8110 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008111 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008112 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8113 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8114 monitor-uri /site_alive
8115 monitor fail if site_dead
8116
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008117 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008118
8119
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008120monitor-uri <uri>
8121 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8123 yes | yes | yes | no
8124 Arguments :
8125 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8126 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8127
8128 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8129 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8130 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8131 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8132 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8133 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8134 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8135 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8136
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008137 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008138 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8139 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau28848542022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008140 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8141 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8142 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008143 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8144 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8145 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008146
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008147 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8148 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8149 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8150 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8151
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008152 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008153 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008154 frontend www
8155 mode http
8156 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8157
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008158 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008160
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008161option abortonclose
8162no option abortonclose
8163 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8165 yes | no | yes | yes
8166 Arguments : none
8167
8168 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8169 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8170 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8171 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008172 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008173 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8174 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8175 encountered while delivering the response.
8176
8177 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8178 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8179 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8180 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8181 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8182 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008183 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008184 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008185 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008186 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8187 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8188 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8189
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008190 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8191 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008192 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8193 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8194 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8195 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8196 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8197 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008198 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008199
8200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8202
8203 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8204
8205
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008206option accept-invalid-http-request
8207no option accept-invalid-http-request
8208 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8210 yes | yes | yes | no
8211 Arguments : none
8212
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008213 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008214 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008215 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008216 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8217 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8218 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8219 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8220 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008221 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8222 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8223 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8224 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008225 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008226 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008227 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8228 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +02008229 and the minor version. Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to
8230 contain fragment references ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008231
8232 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8233 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8234 been confirmed.
8235
8236 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8237 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008238 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8239 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008240 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8241
8242 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8243 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8244
8245 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8246 stats socket.
8247
8248
8249option accept-invalid-http-response
8250no option accept-invalid-http-response
8251 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8253 yes | no | yes | yes
8254 Arguments : none
8255
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008256 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008257 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008258 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008259 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8260 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8261 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8262 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8263 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008264 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8265 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8266 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008267
8268 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8269 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8270 been confirmed.
8271
8272 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8273 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8274 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8275 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8276
8277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8279
8280 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8281 stats socket.
8282
8283
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008284option allbackups
8285no option allbackups
8286 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8288 yes | no | yes | yes
8289 Arguments : none
8290
8291 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8292 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8293 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8294 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8295 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8296 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8297 order between the backup servers anymore.
8298
8299 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8300 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8301
8302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8304
8305
8306option checkcache
8307no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008308 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8310 yes | no | yes | yes
8311 Arguments : none
8312
8313 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8314 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008315 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008316 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8317 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008318 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008319
8320 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008321 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008322 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008323 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8324 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008325 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008326 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008327 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8328 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008329 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008330 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8331 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008332 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008333 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8334 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8335 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8336 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8337 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8338 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8339 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8340 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8341 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8342
8343 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008344 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8345 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8346 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8347 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008348
8349 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8350 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008351 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008352 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008353
8354 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8355 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8356
8357
8358option clitcpka
8359no option clitcpka
8360 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8362 yes | yes | yes | no
8363 Arguments : none
8364
8365 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8366 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008367 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008368 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8369
8370 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8371 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8372 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8373 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8374
8375 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8376 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8377 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8378 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8379 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8380
8381 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8382
8383 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8384 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8385 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8386
8387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8389
8390 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8391
8392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008393option contstats
8394 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8396 yes | yes | yes | no
8397 Arguments : none
8398
8399 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8400 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8401 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008402 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008403 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8404 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8405 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8406 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8407 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008408
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008409option disable-h2-upgrade
8410no option disable-h2-upgrade
8411 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8412 connection.
8413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8414 yes | yes | yes | no
8415 Arguments : none
8416
8417 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8418 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8419 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8420 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008421 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8422 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8423 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8424 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8425 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8426 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008427
8428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008430
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008431option dontlog-normal
8432no option dontlog-normal
8433 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8435 yes | yes | yes | no
8436 Arguments : none
8437
8438 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8439 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8440 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8441 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8442 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8443 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8444 logged.
8445
8446 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8447 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8448 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008450 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008451 logging.
8452
8453
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008454option dontlognull
8455no option dontlognull
8456 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8458 yes | yes | yes | no
8459 Arguments : none
8460
8461 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8462 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8463 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8464 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8465 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8466 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008467 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8468 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8469 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008470
8471 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008472 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008473 would not be logged.
8474
8475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8477
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008478 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008479 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008480
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008481
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008482option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008483 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8485 yes | yes | yes | yes
8486 Arguments :
8487 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8488 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008489 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008490 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008491
8492 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8493 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8494 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8495 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8496 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8497 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8498 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008499 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8500 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8501 possible that the client has already brought one.
8502
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008503 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008504 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008505 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008506 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008507 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008508 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008509
8510 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8511 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8512 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8513 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8514 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8515 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008516 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008517
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008518 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8519 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008520 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008521 are under the control of the end-user.
8522
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008523 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008524 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8525 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008526 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8527 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8528 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008529
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008530 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008531 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8532 frontend www
8533 mode http
8534 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8535
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008536 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8537 backend www
8538 mode http
8539 option forwardfor header X-Client
8540
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008541 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008542 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008543
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008544
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008545option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8546no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8547 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8549 yes | yes | yes | no
8550 Arguments : none
8551
8552 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8553 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8554 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8555 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8556 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8557 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8558 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8559
8560 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8561 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8562 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8563 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8564 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8565 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8566 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8567 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8568 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8569 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8570
8571 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8572
8573 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8574 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8575
8576 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8577 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8578
8579
8580option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8581no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8582 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8584 yes | no | yes | yes
8585 Arguments : none
8586
8587 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8588 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8589 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8590 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8591 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8592 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8593 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8594
8595 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8596 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8597 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8598 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8599 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8600 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8601 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8602 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8603 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8604 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8605
8606 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8607
8608 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8609 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8610
8611 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8612 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8613
8614
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008615option http-buffer-request
8616no option http-buffer-request
8617 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8619 yes | yes | yes | yes
8620 Arguments : none
8621
8622 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8623 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8624 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8625 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8626 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8627 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008628 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8629 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8630 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8631 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008632
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008633 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8634 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008635
8636
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008637option http-ignore-probes
8638no option http-ignore-probes
8639 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8641 yes | yes | yes | no
8642 Arguments : none
8643
8644 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8645 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8646 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8647 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8648 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8649 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8650 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8651 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8652 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008653 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8654 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008655 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8656
8657 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8658 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8659 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8660 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8661 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8662 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8663 are often the only way to detect them.
8664
8665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8667
8668 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8669
8670
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008671option http-keep-alive
8672no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008673 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
8674 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8676 yes | yes | yes | yes
8677 Arguments : none
8678
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008679 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008680 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8681 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8682 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8683 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
8684 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008685
8686 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8687 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008688 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8689 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8690 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8691 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8692 situations where this option may be useful :
8693
8694 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008695 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008696
8697 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8698 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8699
8700 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008701
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008702 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8703 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8704 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8705 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8706 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8707 not set.
8708
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008709 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008710 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008711
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008712 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008713 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008714
8715
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008716option http-no-delay
8717no option http-no-delay
8718 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8720 yes | yes | yes | yes
8721 Arguments : none
8722
8723 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8724 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8725 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8726 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8727 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8728 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8729 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008730 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008731 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8732 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8733 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8734 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8735 affected.
8736
8737 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8738 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8739 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8740 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8741 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8742 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8743 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8744 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8745 latency environments.
8746
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008747 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8748
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008749
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008750option http-pretend-keepalive
8751no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008752 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
8753 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008755 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008756 Arguments : none
8757
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008758 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008759 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
8760 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
8761 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
8762 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
8763 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
8764 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008765
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008766 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008767 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008768 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008769 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008770 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008771 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8772
8773 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8774 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8775 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8776 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008777 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8778 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008779 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8780
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008781 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8782 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8783 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008784 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008785
8786 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8787 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8788
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008789 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008790 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008791
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008792option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8793 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8794 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8796 yes | yes | yes | yes
8797 Arguments :
8798 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8799 with no FastCGI application configured.
8800
8801 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8802 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8803 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8804
8805 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8806 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8807
8808 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8809 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8810 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8811 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8812 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8813 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8814 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8815 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8816
8817 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8818 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008819
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008820option http-server-close
8821no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008822 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8824 yes | yes | yes | yes
8825 Arguments : none
8826
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008827 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008828 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8829 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8830 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8831 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
8832 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
8833 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
8834 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
8835 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
8836 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
8837 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
8838 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
8839 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
8840 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008841
8842 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8843 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8844 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8845 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008846 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8847 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008848
8849 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8850 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008851 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8852 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8853 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008854
8855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8857
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008858 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
8859 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008860
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008861option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008862no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008863 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8865 yes | yes | yes | no
8866 Arguments : none
8867
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008868 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008869 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8870 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8871 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8872 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8873 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008874 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008875
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008876 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008877 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008878 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8879 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8880 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008881
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008882 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8883 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8884 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8885 front of an existing proxy.
8886
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008887 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8888
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008889 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008890
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008891option httpchk
8892option httpchk <uri>
8893option httpchk <method> <uri>
8894option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008895 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8897 yes | no | yes | yes
8898 Arguments :
8899 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8900 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8901 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8902 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8903 ones.
8904
8905 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8906 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8907 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8908
8909 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8910 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8911 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008912 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008913
8914 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8915 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8916 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8917 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8918 the lack of any response.
8919
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008920 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8921 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8922 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8923 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8924
8925 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8926 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8927 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008928
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008929 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8930 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008931 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008932 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008933 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008934
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008935 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8936 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8937 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8938 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8939
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008941 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8942 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8943 backend https_relay
8944 mode tcp
8945 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8946 http-check send hdr Host www
8947 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008948
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008949 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8950 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8951 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008952
8953
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008954option httpclose
8955no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008956 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8958 yes | yes | yes | yes
8959 Arguments : none
8960
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008961 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008962 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8963 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8964 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8965 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008966
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008967 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
8968 connection, depending where the option is set. Only the frontend is
8969 considered for client connections while the frontend and the backend are
8970 considered for server ones. In this case the option is enabled if at least
8971 one of the frontend or backend holding the connection has it enabled. If the
8972 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
8973 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
8974 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008975
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008976 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008977 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
8978 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008979
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008980 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008981 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008982
8983 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8984 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8985
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008986 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008987
8988
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008989option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008990 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008992 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008993 Arguments :
8994 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8995 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8996 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008997 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008998 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008999
9000 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9001 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9002 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9003 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9004 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9005 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9006 ports.
9007
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009008 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9009 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009010
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009011 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009013 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009014
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009015
9016option http_proxy
9017no option http_proxy
9018 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
9019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9020 yes | yes | yes | yes
9021 Arguments : none
9022
9023 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
9024 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
9025 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
9026 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
9027 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
9028
9029 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
9030 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009031 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
9032 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009033
9034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9036
9037 Example :
9038 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9039 backend direct_forward
9040 option httpclose
9041 option http_proxy
9042
9043 See also : "option httpclose"
9044
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009045
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009046option independent-streams
9047no option independent-streams
9048 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9050 yes | yes | yes | yes
9051 Arguments : none
9052
9053 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9054 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9055 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9056 receive data or not.
9057
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009058 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009059 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9060 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9061 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9062 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9063 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9064 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9065 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9066 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9067 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9068 socket buffers.
9069
9070 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9071 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9072 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9073 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9074 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9075
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009076 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009077
9078
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009079option ldap-check
9080 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9082 yes | no | yes | yes
9083 Arguments : none
9084
9085 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9086 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9087 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9088 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9089
9090 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9091 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9092
9093 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9094 configure it.
9095
9096 Example :
9097 option ldap-check
9098
9099 See also : "option httpchk"
9100
9101
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009102option external-check
9103 Use external processes for server health checks
9104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9105 yes | no | yes | yes
9106
9107 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9108 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9109 command".
9110
9111 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9112
9113 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9114
9115
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009116option idle-close-on-response
9117no option idle-close-on-response
9118 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9120 yes | yes | yes | no
9121 Arguments : none
9122
9123 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9124 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9125 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9126 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9127 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9128 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9129 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9130 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9131 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9132
9133 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9134 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9135
9136 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9137 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9138 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9139 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9140
9141 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9142 "hard-stop-after"
9143
9144
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009145option log-health-checks
9146no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009147 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9149 yes | no | yes | yes
9150 Arguments : none
9151
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009152 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9153 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9154 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009155
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009156 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9157 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9158 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9159 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9160 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9161
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009162 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009163 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009164
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009165 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9166 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9167 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009168
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009169
9170option log-separate-errors
9171no option log-separate-errors
9172 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9174 yes | yes | yes | no
9175 Arguments : none
9176
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009177 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009178 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9179 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9180 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9181 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9182 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9183 provides very important information.
9184
9185 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9186 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9187 error logs.
9188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009189 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009190 logging.
9191
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009192
9193option logasap
9194no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009195 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9197 yes | yes | yes | no
9198 Arguments : none
9199
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009200 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9201 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9202 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9203 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9204
9205 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9206 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9207 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9208 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9209 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009210 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009211 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9212 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9213 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9214 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009215 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009216
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009217 Examples :
9218 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9219 mode http
9220 option httplog
9221 option logasap
9222 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9223
9224 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9225 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9226 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9227 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009229 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009230 logging.
9231
9232
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009233option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009234 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9236 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009237 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009238 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9239 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009240 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9241 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009242
9243 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9244 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009245 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009246 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009247 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9248 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9249 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009250
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009251 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9252 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9253 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009254
9255 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009256 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009257 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9258 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9259 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9260 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9261 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9262 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9263 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9264
9265 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9266 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009267
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009268 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009269
9270 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9271 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9272 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9273 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009274 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009275 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009276
9277 See also: "option httpchk"
9278
9279
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009280option nolinger
9281no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009282 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9284 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009285 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009287 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009288 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9289 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9290 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9291 connections.
9292
9293 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9294 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009295 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9296 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9297 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9298 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9299 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9300 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9301 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9302 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9303 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9304 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9305 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9306 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9307 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009308
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009309 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9310 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9311 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9312 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9313 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009314
9315 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9316 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009317 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009318 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009319 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009320
9321 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9322 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9323
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009324 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9325 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009326
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009327option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9328 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9330 yes | yes | yes | yes
9331 Arguments :
9332 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9333 matching <network>
9334 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9335 header name.
9336
9337 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9338 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9339 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9340 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9341 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9342 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9343 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9344 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9345 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9346 possible that the client has already brought one.
9347
9348 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9349 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9350 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9351 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9352 header and requires different one.
9353
9354 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9355 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9356 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009357 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9358 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9359 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9360 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9361 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009362
9363 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9364 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9365 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9366 both are defined.
9367
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009368 Examples :
9369 # Original Destination address
9370 frontend www
9371 mode http
9372 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9373
9374 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9375 backend www
9376 mode http
9377 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9378
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009379 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009380
9381
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009382option persist
9383no option persist
9384 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009387 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009388
9389 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9390 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9391 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9392 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9393 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9394 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9395 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9396 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9397 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9398 redirected to another valid server.
9399
9400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9402
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009403 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009404
9405
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009406option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009407 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9409 yes | no | yes | yes
9410 Arguments :
9411 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9412 PostgreSQL server.
9413
9414 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9415 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9416 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9417 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9418
9419 See also: "option httpchk"
9420
9421
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009422option prefer-last-server
9423no option prefer-last-server
9424 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9426 yes | no | yes | yes
9427 Arguments : none
9428
9429 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009430 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009431 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9432 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009433 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009434 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009435 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009436 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9437 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009438 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009439 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009440 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9441 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9442 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009443 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9444 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9445 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009446
9447 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9448 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9449
9450 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9451
9452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009453option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009454option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009455no option redispatch
9456 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9457 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9458 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009459 Arguments :
9460 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9461 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9462 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009463 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009464 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009465 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009466 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9467 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9468 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9469
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009470
9471 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9472 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9473 be able to access the service anymore.
9474
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009475 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9476 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009477
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009478 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9479 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9480 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9481 following order:
9482
9483 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9484
9485 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9486 list, or
9487
9488 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9489
9490 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9491 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9492
9493 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9494 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9495 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9496 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9497
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009498 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009499 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9500 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009502 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9503 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9504
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009505 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009506
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009507
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009508option redis-check
9509 Use redis health checks for server testing
9510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9511 yes | no | yes | yes
9512 Arguments : none
9513
9514 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9515 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9516 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9517 find the "+PONG" response message.
9518
9519 Example :
9520 option redis-check
9521
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009522 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009523
9524
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009525option smtpchk
9526option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9527 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9529 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009530 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009531 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009532 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009533 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9534
9535 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9536 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9537 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9538
9539 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9540 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9541 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9542 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9543 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9544 dead server.
9545
9546 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9547 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009548 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009549 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9550
9551 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9552 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9553 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9554 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009555 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009556
9557 Example :
9558 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9559
9560 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009563option socket-stats
9564no option socket-stats
9565
9566 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9568 yes | yes | yes | no
9569
9570 Arguments : none
9571
9572
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009573option splice-auto
9574no option splice-auto
9575 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9577 yes | yes | yes | yes
9578 Arguments : none
9579
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009580 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009581 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009582 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009583 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009584 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009585 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9586 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9587 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9588 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9589
9590 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9591 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9592 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9593 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9594 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9595 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9596 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9597 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9598 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9599 keyword.
9600
9601 Example :
9602 option splice-auto
9603
9604 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9605 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9606
9607 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9608 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9609
9610
9611option splice-request
9612no option splice-request
9613 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9615 yes | yes | yes | yes
9616 Arguments : none
9617
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009618 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009619 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009620 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9621 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9622 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9623 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9624
9625 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9626
9627 Example :
9628 option splice-request
9629
9630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9632
9633 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9634 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9635
9636
9637option splice-response
9638no option splice-response
9639 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9641 yes | yes | yes | yes
9642 Arguments : none
9643
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009644 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009645 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009646 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9647 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9648 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9649 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9650
9651 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9652
9653 Example :
9654 option splice-response
9655
9656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9658
9659 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9660 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9661
9662
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009663option spop-check
9664 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01009666 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009667 Arguments : none
9668
9669 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9670 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9671 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9672 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9673
9674 Example :
9675 option spop-check
9676
9677 See also : "option httpchk"
9678
9679
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009680option srvtcpka
9681no option srvtcpka
9682 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 yes | no | yes | yes
9685 Arguments : none
9686
9687 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9688 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009689 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009690 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9691
9692 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9693 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9694 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9695 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9696
9697 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9698 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9699 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9700 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9701 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9702
9703 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9704
9705 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9706 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9707 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9708
9709 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9710 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9711
9712 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9713
9714
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009715option ssl-hello-chk
9716 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9718 yes | no | yes | yes
9719 Arguments : none
9720
9721 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9722 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9723 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9724 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9725 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9726 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9727 hello message.
9728
9729 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9730 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9731 messages, which is appreciable.
9732
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009733 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009734 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9735 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009736
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009737 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9738
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009739
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009740option tcp-check
9741 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9743 yes | no | yes | yes
9744
9745 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9746 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9747
9748 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9749 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9750 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9751
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009752 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009753 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9754 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9755 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9756 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9757 only.
9758
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009759 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009760 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009761 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9762 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9763 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9764
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009765 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009766 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9767 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009768 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009769 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9770 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9771 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9772 the respective protocols.
9773 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009774 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009775
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009776 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009777
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009778 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9779 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9780 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9781 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009782
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009783 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9784 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9785 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009786
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009787
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009788 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009789 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009790 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009791 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009792
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009793 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009794 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009795 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009796
9797 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9798 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009799 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009800 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009801 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009802 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009803 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009804 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009805 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9806 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009807 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009808 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9809 tcp-check expect string +OK
9810
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009811 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009812 (send many headers before analyzing)
9813 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009814 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009815 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9816 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9817 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9818 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009819 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009820
9821
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009822 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009823
9824
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009825option tcp-smart-accept
9826no option tcp-smart-accept
9827 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9829 yes | yes | yes | no
9830 Arguments : none
9831
9832 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9833 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9834 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9835 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9836 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9837 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9838
9839 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9840 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9841 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9842 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9843
9844 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9845 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9846 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009847 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009848
9849 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9850 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9851 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9852
9853 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9854 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9855 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9856
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009857 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9858
9859
9860option tcp-smart-connect
9861no option tcp-smart-connect
9862 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9864 yes | no | yes | yes
9865 Arguments : none
9866
9867 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9868 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9869 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9870 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9871 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9872
9873 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9874 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9875 complex.
9876
9877 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9878 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9879 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9880
9881 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9882 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9883
9884 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9885
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009886
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009887option tcpka
9888 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9890 yes | yes | yes | yes
9891 Arguments : none
9892
9893 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9894 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009895 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009896 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9897
9898 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9899 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9900 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9901 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9902
9903 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9904 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9905 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9906 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9907 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9908
9909 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9910
9911 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9912 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9913 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9914 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9915 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9916 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9917 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9918 backends.
9919
9920 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9921
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009922
9923option tcplog
9924 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009926 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009927 Arguments : none
9928
9929 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9930 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9931 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9932 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9933 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9934 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9935 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9936 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9937
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009938 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009940 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009941
9942
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009943option transparent
9944no option transparent
9945 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009947 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009948 Arguments : none
9949
9950 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9951 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9952 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9953 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9954 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9955 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9956 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9957 appropriate server.
9958
9959 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9960 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9961
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009962 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009963 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009964
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009965
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009966external-check command <command>
9967 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9969 yes | no | yes | yes
9970
9971 Arguments :
9972 <command> is the external command to run
9973
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009974 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9975
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009976 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009977
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009978 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9979 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9980 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9981 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9982 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9983 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009984
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009985 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9986
9987 Environment variables :
9988 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9989 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9990
9991 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9992
9993 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9994
9995 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9996 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9997 for a UNIX socket).
9998
9999 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10000
10001 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10002
10003 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10004
10005 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10006
10007 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10008
10009 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10010 socket).
10011
10012 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10013 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10014
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010015 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10016
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010017 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10018 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10019 failed.
10020
10021 Example :
10022 external-check command /bin/true
10023
10024 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10025
10026
10027external-check path <path>
10028 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10030 yes | no | yes | yes
10031
10032 Arguments :
10033 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10034
10035 The default path is "".
10036
10037 Example :
10038 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10039
10040 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10041 "external-check command"
10042
10043
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010044persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010045persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010046 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10048 yes | no | yes | yes
10049 Arguments :
10050 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010051 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10052 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010053
10054 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10055 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010056 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010057 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10058 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10059 forwarded to this server.
10060
10061 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10062 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10063 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010064 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010065 a single "listen" section.
10066
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010067 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10068 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10069 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10070
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010071 Example :
10072 listen tse-farm
10073 bind :3389
10074 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10075 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10076 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10077 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10078 persist rdp-cookie
10079 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010080 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010081 balance rdp-cookie
10082 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10083 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10084
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010085 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010086
10087
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010088rate-limit sessions <rate>
10089 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10091 yes | yes | yes | no
10092 Arguments :
10093 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10094 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10095
10096 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10097 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10098 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010099 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010100 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10101 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10102
10103 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10104 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10105 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10106 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10107
10108 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10109 listen smtp
10110 mode tcp
10111 bind :25
10112 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010113 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010114
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010115 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10116 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10117 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010118
10119 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10120
10121
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010122redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10123redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10124redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010125 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10127 no | yes | yes | yes
10128
10129 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010130 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010131
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010132 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010133 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010134 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10135 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10136 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010137
10138 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10139 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10140 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10141 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10142 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010143 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10144 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10145 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10146 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010147
10148 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10149 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10150 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10151 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10152 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10153 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010154 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010155 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010156 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10157 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10158 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010159
10160 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010161 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10162 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10163 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010164 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010165 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10166 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10167 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10168 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010169
10170 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010171 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010172
10173 - "drop-query"
10174 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10175 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10176 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10177 with a location-type redirect.
10178
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010179 - "append-slash"
10180 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10181 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10182 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10183 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10184
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010185 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10186 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10187 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10188 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10189 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10190 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10191 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10192
10193 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10194 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10195 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10196 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10197 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10198 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10199 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010200
10201 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10202 acl clear dst_port 80
10203 acl secure dst_port 8080
10204 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010205 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010206 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010207 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10208
10209 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010210 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10211 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10212 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010213 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010214
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010215 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10216 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10217 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10218
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010219 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010220 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010221
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010222 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010223 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10224 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10225 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010227 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010228
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010229
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010230retries <value>
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010231 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10233 yes | no | yes | yes
10234 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010235 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10236 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010237
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010238 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10239 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10240 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10241 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10242 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010243
10244 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010245 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010246 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010247
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010248 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10249 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10250 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010251
10252 See also : "option redispatch"
10253
10254
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010255retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010256 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10257 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10258 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010259 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10260 yes | no | yes | yes
10261 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010262 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10263 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10264 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10265 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10266 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010267
10268 none never retry
10269
10270 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10271 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10272
10273 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10274 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10275 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10276 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10277 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10278 processing the request.
10279
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010280 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10281 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10282 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10283 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10284 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10285 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10286 overflow attack for example).
10287
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010288 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10289 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10290 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10291 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10292 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10293 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10294 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10295 amplify denial of service attacks.
10296
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010297 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10298 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10299 considered to be safe to retry.
10300
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010301 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10302 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10303 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10304 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10305 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010306
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010307 all-retryable-errors
10308 retry request for any error that are considered
10309 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10310 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10311 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10312
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010313 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10314 not cumulative.
10315
10316 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10317 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10318 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10319 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10320
10321 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10322 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10323 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10324 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10325 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10326 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10327 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10328 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10329 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10330 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10331 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10332 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10333
10334 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10335 should not use this directive.
10336
10337 The default is "conn-failure".
10338
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010339 Example:
10340 retry-on 503 504
10341
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010342 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10343
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010344server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010345 Declare a server in a backend
10346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10347 no | no | yes | yes
10348 Arguments :
10349 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010350 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010351 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010352
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010353 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10354 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10355 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10356 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010357 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10358 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010359 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010360 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10361 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010362 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10363 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10364 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10365 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10366 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10367 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10368 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010369 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010370 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10371 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10372 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10373 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10374 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10375 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010376 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10377 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010378 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10379 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010380
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010381 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010382 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10383 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10384 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10385 adding this value to the client's port.
10386
10387 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10388 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010389 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010390
10391 Examples :
10392 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10393 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010394 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010395 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10396 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10397 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010398
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010399 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10400 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10401 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10402 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10403 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10404
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010405 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10406 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010407
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010408server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010409 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010410 this backend.
10411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10412 no | no | yes | yes
10413
10414 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10415 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10416 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10417 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10418 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010419
10420 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10421 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10422
10423 global
10424 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10425
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010426 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010427 load-server-state-from-file
10428
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010429 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010430 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010431
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010432server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10433 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10434 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10436 no | no | yes | yes
10437
10438 Arguments:
10439 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10440
10441 <num | range>
10442 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10443 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10444 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10445 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10446
10447 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10448
10449 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10450
10451 <params*>
10452 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10453 keyword.
10454
10455 Examples:
10456 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10457 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10458 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10459
10460 # or
10461 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10462
10463 # would be equivalent to:
10464 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10465 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10466 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10467
10468
10469
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010470source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010471source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010472source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010473 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10475 yes | no | yes | yes
10476 Arguments :
10477 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10478 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010479
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010480 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010481 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10482 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10483 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10484 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10485 supported prefixes are :
10486 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10487 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10488 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010489 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010490 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10491 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010492
10493 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10494 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010495 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10496 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10497 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010498
10499 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10500 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10501 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10502 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10503 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10504 <addr>.
10505
10506 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10507 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10508 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10509 port.
10510
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010511 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10512 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10513 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10514 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010515 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010516 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10517 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10518 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10519 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10520 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10521 HTTP header.
10522
10523 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10524 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010525 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010526 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10527 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10528 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10529 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10530 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10531 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10532 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10533
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010534 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10535 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10536 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10537 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10538 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10539 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10540
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010541 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10542 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10543 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10544 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10545
10546 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10547 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10548 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10549 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10550 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10551 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10552
10553 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10554 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10555 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10556 there are two methods :
10557
10558 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10559 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10560 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10561 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10562 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10563 of the client ranges may be used.
10564
10565 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10566 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10567 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10568 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10569 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10570 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10571 same session.
10572
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010573 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10574 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10575 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010576 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010577
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010578 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10579
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010580 Examples :
10581 backend private
10582 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10583 source 192.168.1.200
10584
10585 backend transparent_ssl1
10586 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10587 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10588
10589 backend transparent_ssl2
10590 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10591 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10592 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10593
10594 backend transparent_ssl3
10595 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10596 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10597 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10598
10599 backend transparent_smtp
10600 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10601 # with Tproxy version 4.
10602 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10603
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010604 backend transparent_http
10605 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10606 # proxy.
10607 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010609 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010610 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10611
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010612
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010613srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10614 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10615 the connection on the server side.
10616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10617 yes | no | yes | yes
10618 Arguments :
10619 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10620
10621 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10622 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010623 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10624 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010625
10626 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10627
10628
10629srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10630 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10631 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10632 server side.
10633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10634 yes | no | yes | yes
10635 Arguments :
10636 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10637 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10638 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10639 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10640
10641 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10642 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010643 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10644 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010645
10646 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10647
10648
10649srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10650 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10652 yes | no | yes | yes
10653 Arguments :
10654 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10655 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10656 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10657 document.
10658
10659 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10660 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010661 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10662 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010663
10664 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10665
10666
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010667stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10668 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010670 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010671
10672 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10673 matched.
10674
10675 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10676 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10677
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010678 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10679 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010680 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010681
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010682 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10683 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10684 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10685 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010686
10687 Example :
10688 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10689 backend stats_localhost
10690 stats enable
10691 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10692
10693 Example :
10694 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10695 backend stats_auth
10696 stats enable
10697 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10698 stats admin if TRUE
10699
10700 Example :
10701 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10702 userlist stats-auth
10703 group admin users admin
10704 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10705 group readonly users haproxy
10706 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10707
10708 backend stats_auth
10709 stats enable
10710 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10711 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10712 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10713 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10714
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010715 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10716 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10717 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010718
10719
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010720stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10721 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010724 Arguments :
10725 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10726
10727 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10728
10729 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10730 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10731 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10732 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10733 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10734 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10735
10736 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10737 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10738 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010739 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010740
10741 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10742 report using "stats scope".
10743
10744 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10745 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10746 unobvious parameters.
10747
10748 Example :
10749 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10750 backend public_www
10751 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10752 stats enable
10753 stats hide-version
10754 stats scope .
10755 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010756 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010757 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10758 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10759
10760 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10761 backend private_monitoring
10762 stats enable
10763 stats uri /admin?stats
10764 stats refresh 5s
10765
10766 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10767
10768
10769stats enable
10770 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010772 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010773 Arguments : none
10774
10775 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10776 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10777 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10778 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10779 - stats auth : no authentication
10780 - stats scope : no restriction
10781
10782 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10783 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10784 unobvious parameters.
10785
10786 Example :
10787 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10788 backend public_www
10789 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10790 stats enable
10791 stats hide-version
10792 stats scope .
10793 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010794 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010795 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10796 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10797
10798 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10799 backend private_monitoring
10800 stats enable
10801 stats uri /admin?stats
10802 stats refresh 5s
10803
10804 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10805
10806
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010807stats hide-version
10808 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010810 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010811 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010812
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010813 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10814 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10815 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10816 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10817 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10818 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010820 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10821 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10822 unobvious parameters.
10823
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010824 Example :
10825 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10826 backend public_www
10827 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010828 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010829 stats hide-version
10830 stats scope .
10831 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010832 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010833 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10834 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010835
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010836 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10837 backend private_monitoring
10838 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010839 stats uri /admin?stats
10840 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010841
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010842 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010843
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010844
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010845stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10846 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10847 Access control for statistics
10848
10849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10850 no | no | yes | yes
10851
10852 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10853 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10854 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10855 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10856 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10857 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10858
10859 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10860 instance.
10861
10862 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10863 about ACL usage.
10864
10865
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010866stats realm <realm>
10867 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010869 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010870 Arguments :
10871 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10872 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10873 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10874
10875 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10876 using a backslash ('\').
10877
10878 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10879 only related to authentication.
10880
10881 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10882 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10883 unobvious parameters.
10884
10885 Example :
10886 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10887 backend public_www
10888 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10889 stats enable
10890 stats hide-version
10891 stats scope .
10892 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010893 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010894 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10895 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10896
10897 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10898 backend private_monitoring
10899 stats enable
10900 stats uri /admin?stats
10901 stats refresh 5s
10902
10903 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10904
10905
10906stats refresh <delay>
10907 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010909 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010910 Arguments :
10911 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10912 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10913 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10914 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10915 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10916 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10917
10918 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10919 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10920 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010921 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010922
10923 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10924 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10925 unobvious parameters.
10926
10927 Example :
10928 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10929 backend public_www
10930 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10931 stats enable
10932 stats hide-version
10933 stats scope .
10934 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010935 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010936 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10937 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10938
10939 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10940 backend private_monitoring
10941 stats enable
10942 stats uri /admin?stats
10943 stats refresh 5s
10944
10945 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10946
10947
10948stats scope { <name> | "." }
10949 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010951 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010952 Arguments :
10953 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10954 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10955 section in which the statement appears.
10956
10957 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10958 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10959 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10960 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10961 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10962 exists.
10963
10964 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10965 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10966 unobvious parameters.
10967
10968 Example :
10969 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10970 backend public_www
10971 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10972 stats enable
10973 stats hide-version
10974 stats scope .
10975 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010976 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010977 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10978 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10979
10980 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10981 backend private_monitoring
10982 stats enable
10983 stats uri /admin?stats
10984 stats refresh 5s
10985
10986 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10987
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010988
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010989stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010990 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010992 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010993
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010994 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010995 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10996
10997 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10998 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10999
11000 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11001 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011002 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011003
11004 Example :
11005 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11006 backend private_monitoring
11007 stats enable
11008 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11009 stats uri /admin?stats
11010 stats refresh 5s
11011
11012 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11013 global section.
11014
11015
11016stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011017 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11019 yes | yes | yes | yes
11020 Arguments : none
11021
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011022 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011023 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11024 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11025 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11026 - IP (socket, server)
11027 - cookie (backend, server)
11028
11029 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11030 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011031 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011032
11033 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11034
11035
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011036stats show-modules
11037 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11039 yes | yes | yes | yes
11040 Arguments : none
11041
11042 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11043 values as a tooltip.
11044
11045 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11046 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11047 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11048
11049 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11050
11051
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011052stats show-node [ <name> ]
11053 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011055 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011056 Arguments:
11057 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11058 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11059
11060 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11061 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011062 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011063
11064 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11065 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11066 unobvious parameters.
11067
11068 Example:
11069 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11070 backend private_monitoring
11071 stats enable
11072 stats show-node Europe-1
11073 stats uri /admin?stats
11074 stats refresh 5s
11075
11076 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11077 section.
11078
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011079
11080stats uri <prefix>
11081 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011083 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011084 Arguments :
11085 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11086 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11087 query string.
11088
11089 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11090 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11091 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11092 possible to reach it in the application.
11093
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011094 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011095 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011096 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11097 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11098 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11099 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11100
11101 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11102 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11103 an address or a port to statistics only.
11104
11105 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11106 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11107 unobvious parameters.
11108
11109 Example :
11110 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11111 backend public_www
11112 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11113 stats enable
11114 stats hide-version
11115 stats scope .
11116 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011117 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011118 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11119 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11120
11121 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11122 backend private_monitoring
11123 stats enable
11124 stats uri /admin?stats
11125 stats refresh 5s
11126
11127 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11128
11129
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011130stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11131 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011133 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011134
11135 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011136 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011137 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011138 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011139 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11140
11141 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11142 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11143 the "stick-table" statement.
11144
11145 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11146 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11147 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11148 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11149 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11150
11151 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11152 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11153 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11154 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11155 transformation rules.
11156
11157 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11158 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11159 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11160 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11161 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11162 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11163 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11164
11165 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11166 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11167 ACL based conditions.
11168
11169 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11170 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11171 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11172 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11173
11174 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11175 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11176 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11177 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11178
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011179 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11180 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011181 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011182
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011183 Example :
11184 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11185 # last 30 minutes
11186 backend pop
11187 mode tcp
11188 balance roundrobin
11189 stick store-request src
11190 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11191 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11192 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11193
11194 backend smtp
11195 mode tcp
11196 balance roundrobin
11197 stick match src table pop
11198 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11199 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11200
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011201 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011202 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011203
11204
11205stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11206 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11208 no | no | yes | yes
11209
11210 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11211 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11212 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11213 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11214
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011215 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11216 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011217 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011218
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011219 Examples :
11220 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011221 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011222
11223 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11224 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11225 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11226
11227
11228 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11229 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11230 backend http
11231 mode http
11232 balance roundrobin
11233 stick on src table https
11234 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11235 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11236 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11237
11238 backend https
11239 mode tcp
11240 balance roundrobin
11241 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11242 stick on src
11243 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11244 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11245
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011246 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011247
11248
11249stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11250 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11252 no | no | yes | yes
11253
11254 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011255 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011256 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011257 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011258 server is selected.
11259
11260 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11261 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11262 the "stick-table" statement.
11263
11264 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11265 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11266 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11267 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11268 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11269 address.
11270
11271 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11272 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11273 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11274 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11275 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11276 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11277 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11278 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11279 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11280 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11281
11282 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11283 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11284 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11285 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11286 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11287 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11288 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11289
11290 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11291 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11292 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11293 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11294
11295 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11296 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11297 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11298 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11299 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11300 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011301 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11302 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11303 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11304 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11305 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11306 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011307
11308 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11309 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11310 the request.
11311
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011312 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11313 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011314 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011315
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011316 Example :
11317 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11318 # last 30 minutes
11319 backend pop
11320 mode tcp
11321 balance roundrobin
11322 stick store-request src
11323 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11324 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11325 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11326
11327 backend smtp
11328 mode tcp
11329 balance roundrobin
11330 stick match src table pop
11331 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11332 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11333
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011334 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011335 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011336
11337
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011338stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011339 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011340 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011341 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011343 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011344
11345 Arguments :
11346 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11347 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11348 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11349 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11350
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011351 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11352 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11353 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11354 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11355
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011356 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11357 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11358 instance.
11359
11360 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11361 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11362 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11363 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11364 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11365 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011366 to 32 characters.
11367
11368 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11369 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11370 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011371 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011372 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11373 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011374
11375 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011376 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11377 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011378 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11379 increase.
11380
11381 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011382 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11383 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11384 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011385
11386 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011387 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011388 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11389 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011390 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011391 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11392 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11393 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11394 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11395 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11396 parameter (see below).
11397
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011398 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11399 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11400 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11401 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11402 soft restart.
11403
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011404 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11405 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011406
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011407 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011408 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11409 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011410 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11411 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011412 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011413 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011414 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11415 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011416 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11417 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011418
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011419 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11420 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11421 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11422 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11423 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11424 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11425 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11426 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11427 token.
11428
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011429 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11430 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11431 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11432 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011433 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11434 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11435 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11436 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11437 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11438 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11439 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11440 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11441 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11442 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11443 types and their arguments.
11444
11445 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11446 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11447 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11448 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11449
11450 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11451 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11452 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011453 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011454
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011455 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11456 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11457 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011458 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011459 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011460 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011461
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011462 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11463 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11464 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11465 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11466
11467 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11468 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11469 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11470 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11471 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11472 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11473
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011474 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11475 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11476 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11477 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11478
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011479 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11480 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11481 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11482 they were received.
11483
11484 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11485 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11486 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11487 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11488 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11489
11490 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11491 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11492 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11493 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11494 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11495
11496 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11497 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11498 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11499
11500 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11501 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11502 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11503 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11504 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11505
11506 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11507 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11508 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11509 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11510 the client side.
11511
11512 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11513 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11514 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11515 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11516 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11517 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11518 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11519
11520 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11521 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11522 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11523 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11524 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11525 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011526 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011527
11528 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11529 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11530 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11531 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11532 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11533 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11534
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011535 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11536 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11537 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11538 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11539 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11540
11541 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11542 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11543 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11544 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11545 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11546 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11547
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011548 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011549 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011550 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11551 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11552
11553 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11554 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11555 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11556 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11557 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11558 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11559 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11560 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11561 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11562 recommended for better fairness.
11563
11564 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011565 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011566 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11567 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11568
11569 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11570 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11571 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11572 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11573 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11574 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11575 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11576 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11577 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11578 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011579
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011580 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11581 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011582 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11583 reference it.
11584
11585 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11586 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011587 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11588 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11589 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011590
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011591 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11592 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11593 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11594 something that can be ignored.
11595
11596 Example:
11597 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11598 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11599 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11600 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11601
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011602 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011603 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011604
11605
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011606stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011607 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11609 no | no | yes | yes
11610
11611 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011612 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011613 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011614 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011615 server is selected.
11616
11617 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11618 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11619 the "stick-table" statement.
11620
11621 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11622 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11623 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11624 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11625
11626 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11627 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11628 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11629 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11630 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11631 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011632 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011633 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11634 rules.
11635
11636 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11637 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11638 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11639 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11640 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11641 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11642 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11643
11644 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11645 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11646 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11647 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11648
11649 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11650 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11651 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11652 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11653 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11654 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011655 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11656 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11657 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11658 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11659 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11660 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11661 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11662 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11663 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011664
11665 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11666
11667 Example :
11668 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11669 backend https
11670 mode tcp
11671 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011672 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011673 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011674
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011675 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
William Lallemand858ed9a2023-12-07 15:00:58 +010011676 acl serverhello res.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011677
11678 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11679 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11680 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11681
11682 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11683 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011684
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011685 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11686 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11687 # at offset 44.
11688
11689 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011690 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011691
11692 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011693 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011694
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011695 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11696 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11697
11698 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11699 extraction.
11700
11701
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011702tcp-check comment <string>
11703 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11704 it fails.
11705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11706 yes | no | yes | yes
11707
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011708 Arguments :
11709 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11710 rule fails.
11711
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011712 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11713 user-friendly error reporting.
11714
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011715 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11716 "tcp-check expect".
11717
11718
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011719tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11720 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011721 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011722 Opens a new connection
11723 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011724 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011725
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011726 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011727 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11728
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011729 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011730 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011731
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011732 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011733 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11734 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011735 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011736
11737 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011738
11739 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11740
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011741 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11742
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011743 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11744
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011745 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11746
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011747 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11748 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11749 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11750 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11751
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011752 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11753 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11754 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11755 haproxy -vv.
11756
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011757 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011758
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011759 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11760 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11761 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11762
11763 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11764 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11765 of the sequence.
11766
11767 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11768 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11769 do.
11770
11771 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11772 unset-var or comment rules.
11773
11774 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011775 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11776 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11777 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11778 option tcp-check
11779 tcp-check connect
11780 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11781 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11782 tcp-check send \r\n
11783 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11784 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11785 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11786 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11787 tcp-check send \r\n
11788 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11789 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11790
11791 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11792 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011793 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011794 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11795 tcp-check connect port 143
11796 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11797 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11798
11799 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11800
11801
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011802tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011803 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011804 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011805 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011806 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011808 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011809
11810 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011811 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11812
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011813 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11814 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11815 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11816 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11817 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11818 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11819 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11820 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11821 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11822 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11823
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011824 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011825 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11826 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011827 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11828 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11829 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11830
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011831 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11832 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11833 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011834 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11835 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011836 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11837 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011838 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11839 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011840 By default "L7OK" is used.
11841
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011842 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11843 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011844 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11845 supported :
11846 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11847 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011848 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11849 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11850 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11851 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11852 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011853
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011854 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011855 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011856 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11857 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11858 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11859 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011860 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11861
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011862 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11863 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11864 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11865 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11866
11867 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11868 informational message reported in logs if an error
11869 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11870 log-format string.
11871
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011872 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11873 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11874 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11875 followed by some converters.
11876
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011877 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11878 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11879 with the usual backslash ('\').
11880 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011881 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011882 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11883 used upper or lower case.
11884
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011885 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11886
11887 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11888 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11889 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11890 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11891 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11892 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11893 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11894 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11895
11896 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11897 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11898 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11899 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11900 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11901 expression.
11902
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011903 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11904 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11905 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11906 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11907 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11908 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11909
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011910 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11911 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11912 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11913 this exact hexadecimal string.
11914 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11915
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011916 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11917 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11918 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11919 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11920 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11921 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11922 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11923 size.
11924
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011925 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11926 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11927 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11928 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11929 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11930 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11931 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11932 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11933 in a binary string before matching the response's
11934 buffer.
11935
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011936 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011937 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011938 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11939 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11940 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11941 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11942 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11943 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11944 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11945 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11946 the null character.
11947
11948 Examples :
11949 # perform a POP check
11950 option tcp-check
11951 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11952
11953 # perform an IMAP check
11954 option tcp-check
11955 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11956
11957 # look for the redis master server
11958 option tcp-check
11959 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011960 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011961 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11962 tcp-check expect string role:master
11963 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11964 tcp-check expect string +OK
11965
11966
11967 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011968 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011969
11970
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011971tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11972tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11973 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11974 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011976 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011977
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011978 Arguments :
11979 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11980
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011981 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11982 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011983
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011984 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11985 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011986
11987 Examples :
11988 # look for the redis master server
11989 option tcp-check
11990 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11991 tcp-check expect string role:master
11992
11993 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011994 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011995
11996
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011997tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11998tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11999 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12000 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012002 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012003
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012004 Arguments :
12005 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012006
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012007 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12008 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012009
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012010 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12011 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12012 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012013
12014 Examples :
12015 # redis check in binary
12016 option tcp-check
12017 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12018 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12019
12020
12021 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012022 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012023
12024
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012025tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012026 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012027 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012028 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012029
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012030 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012031 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12032 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12033 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12034 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12035 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12036 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12037 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12038 and '-'.
12039
12040 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012042 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012043 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12044
12045
12046tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012047 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012049 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012050
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012051 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012052 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12053 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12054 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12055 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12056 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12057 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12058 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12059 and '-'.
12060
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012061 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012062 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12063
12064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012065tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12066 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12068 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012069 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012070 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12071 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012073 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012074
12075 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12076 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012077 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12078 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12079 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12080 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12081 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12082 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012083
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012084 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12085 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12086 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12087 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012088
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012089 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012090 - accept :
12091 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12092 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12093 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012095 - reject :
12096 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12097 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12098 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12099 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12100 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12101 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12102 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12103 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12104 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12105 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12106 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012107 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012108
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012109 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12110 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12111 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12112 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12113 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12114 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12115 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12116 hosts.
12117
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012118 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12119 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12120 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12121 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12122 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12123 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12124 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12125 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12126
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012127 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12128 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12129 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12130 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12131 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12132 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12133 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12134 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12135 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012136 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12137 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012138
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012139 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012140 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012141 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12142 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12143 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012144 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012145 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012146 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12147 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12148 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12149 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12150 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12151 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12152 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012153
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012154 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012155 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012156 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012157 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012158 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12159 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12160 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012161
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012162 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12163 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12164 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12165 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012166
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012167 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12168 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12169 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12170 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12171 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012172 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12173 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12174 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12175 layer7 information is extracted.
12176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012177 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12178 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12179 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12180 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12181 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012182
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012183 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12184 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12185 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12186 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12187
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012188 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12189 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12190 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12191 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12192
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012193 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12194 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12195 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12196 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12197 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012198
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012199 - set-src <expr> :
12200 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12201 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12202 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012203 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012204
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012205 Arguments:
12206 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12207 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012208
12209 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012210 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12211
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012212 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12213 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012214
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012215 - set-src-port <expr> :
12216 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12217 expression.
12218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012219 Arguments:
12220 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12221 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012222
12223 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012224 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12225
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012226 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12227 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12228 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012229
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012230 - set-dst <expr> :
12231 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12232 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12233 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12234 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12235 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12236
12237 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12238 followed by some converters.
12239
12240 Example:
12241
12242 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12243 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12244
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012245 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12246 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12247
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012248 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12249 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12250 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12251 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12252
12253
12254 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12255 followed by some converters.
12256
12257 Example:
12258
12259 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12260
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012261 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12262 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12263 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12264
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012265 - "silent-drop" :
12266 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012267 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012268 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12269 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12270 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12271 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12272 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012273 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12274 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012275 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12276 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012277 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012278 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12279 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12280 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12281 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012283 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12284 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12285 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012287 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12288 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12289 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012290
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012291 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012292 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012293 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012294
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012295 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12296 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12297 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012298
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012299 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012300 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12301 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012302
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012303 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12304
12305 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12306
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012307 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12308
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012309 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012310
12311
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012312tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12313 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012315 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012316 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012317 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12318 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012319
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012320 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012321
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012322 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012323 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12324 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012325 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12326 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012327
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012328 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12329 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12330 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12331 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012332 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012333 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012334 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12335 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12336 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12337 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012338 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012339 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012340
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012341 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12342 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12343 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12344 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012345
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012346 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012347 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012348 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012349 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12350 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012351 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012352 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012353 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012354 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012355 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012356 - set-dst <expr>
12357 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012358 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012359 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012360 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012361 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012362 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012363 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012364
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012365 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12366 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012367 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12368 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012369
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012370 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12371 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12372 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12373 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12374 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12375 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012377 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012378 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12379 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012380
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012381 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12382 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12383 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12384 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12385 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12386 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12387
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012388 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012389 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12390 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12391 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12392 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12393 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12394 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12395 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12396 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12397 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12398 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012399
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012400 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012401 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12402 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12403 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012404
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012405 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12406 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12407
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012408 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012409 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12410 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012411
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012412 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12413 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012414 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012415 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12416 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012417 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012418 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012419 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012420 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12421 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012422 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012423 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12424 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012425
12426 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12427 followed by some converters.
12428
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012429 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012430 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12431 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12432 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12433 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12434 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12435 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012436 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012437 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12438 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12439
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012440 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12441
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012442 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12443 <var-name>.
12444
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012445 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12446 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12447 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12448 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12449 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12450
12451 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12452 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12453 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12454 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12455 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12456 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12457 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12458 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12459 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12460 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12461 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12462
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012463 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12464 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12465 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12466 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12467 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12468
12469 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12470
12471 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12472
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012473 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12474 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12475 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12476 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12477 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12478 evaluated.
12479
12480 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012481 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012482
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012483 Example:
12484
12485 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012486 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012487
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012488 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012489 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012490 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012491 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12492 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012493 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012494 tcp-request content reject
12495
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012496 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12497 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12498 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12499 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12500 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12501 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12502 ...
12503 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12504
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012505 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012506 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12507 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012508 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012509 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012510
12511 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12512 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012513 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012514 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012515 tcp-request content reject
12516
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012517 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012518 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012519 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012520 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012521 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12522 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012523
12524 Example:
12525 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12526 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012527 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012528
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012529 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012530 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012531
12532 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012533 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012534 # protecting all our sites
12535 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012536 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12537 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012538 ...
12539 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12540
12541 backend http_dynamic
12542 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012543 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012544 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012545 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012546 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012547 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012548 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012550 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012551
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012552 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12553 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012554
12555
12556tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12557 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012559 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012560 Arguments :
12561 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12562 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12563 as explained at the top of this document.
12564
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012565 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012566 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12567 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12568 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12569 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12570
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012571 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12572 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12573 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12574 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12575
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012576 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012577 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012578 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012579 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012580 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012581 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12582 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12583 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012584
Christopher Faulet3e2a39e2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020012585 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
12586 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
12587
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012588 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12589 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12590 it pass through unaffected.
12591
12592 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12593 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12594 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012595 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012596 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12597 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012598 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12599 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12600 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012601
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012602 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012603 "timeout client".
12604
12605
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012606tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12607 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12609 no | no | yes | yes
12610 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012611 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12612 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012613
12614 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12615
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012616 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012617 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12618 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012619 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12620 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012621
12622 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12623
12624 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12625 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12626 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12627 inserted.
12628
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012629 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012630 - accept :
12631 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12632 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12633 the rules evaluation.
12634
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012635 - close :
12636 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12637 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12638 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12639 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12640 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12641 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012642 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012643 protocols.
12644
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012645 - reject :
12646 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12647 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012648 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012649
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012650 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012651 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012652
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012653 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12654 Unsets a variable.
12655
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012656 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12657 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12658 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12659 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12660
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012661 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12662 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12663 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12664 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12665
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012666 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12667 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12668 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12669 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12670 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012671
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012672 - "silent-drop" :
12673 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012674 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012675 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12676 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12677 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12678 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12679 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012680 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12681 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012682 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12683 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012684 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012685 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12686 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12687 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12688 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12689
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012690 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12691 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12692
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012693 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12694 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12695 for changing the default action to a reject.
12696
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012697 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12698 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12699 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12700 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012701 period.
12702
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012703 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12704 declared inline.
12705
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012706 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12707 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012708 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012709 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12710 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012711 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012712 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012713 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012714 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12715 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012716 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012717 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12718 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012719
12720 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12721 followed by some converters.
12722
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012723 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12724 <var-name>.
12725
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012726 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12727 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12728 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12729 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12730 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12731
12732 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12733
12734 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12735
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012736 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12737
12738 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12739
12740
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012741tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12742 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12744 no | yes | yes | no
12745 Arguments :
12746 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12747 below.
12748
12749 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012751 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012752 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12753 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12754 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12755 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12756 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12757 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12758 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012759 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012760 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12761 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12762 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12763 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12764 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12765 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12766 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12767 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12768 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12769 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12770 instead.
12771
12772 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12773 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12774 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12775 rules which may be inserted.
12776
12777 Several types of actions are supported :
12778 - accept : the request is accepted
12779 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12780 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12781 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012782 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012783 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012784 - set-dst <expr>
12785 - set-dst-port <expr>
12786 - set-src <expr>
12787 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012788 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012789 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012790 - silent-drop
12791
12792 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12793 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12794 sections for a complete description.
12795
12796 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12797 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12798 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12799
12800 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12801 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12802 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12803 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12804 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12805
12806 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12807 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12808
12809 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12810 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12811 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12812
12813 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12814 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12815 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12816
12817 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12818 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12819 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12820
12821 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12822 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12823 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12824
12825 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12826
12827 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12828
12829
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012830tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12831 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12833 no | no | yes | yes
12834 Arguments :
12835 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12836 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12837 as explained at the top of this document.
12838
12839 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12840
12841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012842timeout check <timeout>
12843 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12844 established.
12845
12846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12847 yes | no | yes | yes
12848 Arguments:
12849 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12850 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12851 as explained at the top of this document.
12852
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012853 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012854 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012855 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012856 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012857 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12858 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12859 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012860
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012861 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012862 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12863
12864 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12865 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012866 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012867
12868 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12869 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12870 forget about it.
12871
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012872 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12873 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012874
12875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012876timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012877 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12879 yes | yes | yes | no
12880 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012881 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012882 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12883 as explained at the top of this document.
12884
12885 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12886 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12887 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012888 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12889 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12890 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12891 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012892 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12893 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12894 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012895 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012896 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012897 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12898 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012899 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12900 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012901
12902 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12903 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12904 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12905 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012906 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012907 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12908
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012909 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012910
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012911
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012912timeout client-fin <timeout>
12913 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12915 yes | yes | yes | no
12916 Arguments :
12917 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12918 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12919 as explained at the top of this document.
12920
12921 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12922 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12923 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12924 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12925 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12926 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12927 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012928 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12929 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12930 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012931
12932 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12933 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12934 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12935
12936 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12937
12938
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012939timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012940 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12942 yes | no | yes | yes
12943 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012944 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012945 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12946 as explained at the top of this document.
12947
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012948 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012949 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012950 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012951 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012952 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12953 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012954
12955 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12956 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12957 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12958 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012959 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012960 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12961
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012962 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012964
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012965timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12966 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12968 yes | yes | yes | yes
12969 Arguments :
12970 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12971 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12972 as explained at the top of this document.
12973
12974 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12975 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12976 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12977 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12978 once the request has started to present itself.
12979
12980 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12981 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12982 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12983 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12984 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12985
12986 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12987 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12988 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12989 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12990
12991 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12992 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012993 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012994 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12995 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012996 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012997
12998 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12999 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13000 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13001 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13002
13003 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13004
13005
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013006timeout http-request <timeout>
13007 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013009 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013010 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013011 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013012 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13013 as explained at the top of this document.
13014
13015 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13016 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13017 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13018 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13019 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13020 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13021 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013022 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13023 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13024 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13025 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013026 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013027 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13028 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013029
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013030 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13031 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13032 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13033 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13034 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013035 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013036
13037 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13038 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013039 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013040 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13041 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13042
13043 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013044 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13045 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13046 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013047
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013048 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013049 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013050
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013051
13052timeout queue <timeout>
13053 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13055 yes | no | yes | yes
13056 Arguments :
13057 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13058 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13059 as explained at the top of this document.
13060
13061 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13062 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13063 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13064 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13065 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13066
13067 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13068 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13069 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13070 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13071
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013072 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013073
13074
13075timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013076 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13078 yes | no | yes | yes
13079 Arguments :
13080 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13081 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13082 as explained at the top of this document.
13083
13084 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13085 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13086 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13087 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13088 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13089 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13090 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13091
13092 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13093 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13094 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13095 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13096 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013097 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013098 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013099 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13100 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013101 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13102 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013103
13104 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13105 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13106 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13107 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013108 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013109 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13110
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013111 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013112
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013113
13114timeout server-fin <timeout>
13115 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13117 yes | no | yes | yes
13118 Arguments :
13119 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13120 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13121 as explained at the top of this document.
13122
13123 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13124 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13125 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13126 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13127 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13128 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13129 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13130 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13131 situations, it should not be needed.
13132
13133 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13134 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13135 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13136
13137 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13138
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013139
13140timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013141 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13143 yes | yes | yes | yes
13144 Arguments :
13145 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13146 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13147 as explained at the top of this document.
13148
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013149 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13150 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13151 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013152
13153 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13154 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13155 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13156 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013157 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013158
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013159 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013160
13161
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013162timeout tunnel <timeout>
13163 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13165 yes | no | yes | yes
13166 Arguments :
13167 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13168 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13169 as explained at the top of this document.
13170
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013171 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013172 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13173 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13174 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013175 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13176 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013177 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13178 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13179 specified.
13180
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013181 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13182 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13183 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13184 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13185 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13186 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13187 state.
13188
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013189 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13190 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13191 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13192 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013193 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013194
13195 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13196 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13197 forget about it.
13198
13199 Example :
13200 defaults http
13201 option http-server-close
13202 timeout connect 5s
13203 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013204 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013205 timeout server 30s
13206 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13207
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013208 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013209
13210
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013211transparent (deprecated)
13212 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013214 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013215 Arguments : none
13216
13217 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13218 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13219 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13220 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13221 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13222 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13223 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13224 appropriate server.
13225
13226 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13227
13228 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13229 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13230
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013231 See also: "option transparent"
13232
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013233unique-id-format <string>
13234 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13236 yes | yes | yes | no
13237 Arguments :
13238 <string> is a log-format string.
13239
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013240 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13241 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13242 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13243 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013244
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013245 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013246 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013247 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13248 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13249 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13250 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13251 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13252 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013253
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013254 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13255 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013256
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013257 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013258
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013259 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013260
13261 will generate:
13262
13263 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13264
13265 See also: "unique-id-header"
13266
13267unique-id-header <name>
13268 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13270 yes | yes | yes | no
13271 Arguments :
13272 <name> is the name of the header.
13273
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013274 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13275 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013276
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013277 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013278
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013279 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013280 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13281
13282 will generate:
13283
13284 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13285
13286 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013287
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013288use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013289 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13291 no | yes | yes | no
13292 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013293 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13294 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013295
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013296 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13297 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013298
13299 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13300 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13301 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013302 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013303 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013304 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13305 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013306
13307 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13308 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13309 assign the backend.
13310
13311 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13312 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13313 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13314 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13315 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13316 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13317
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013318 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013319 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013320 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13321 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13322 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13323
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013324 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13325 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13326 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13327 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13328 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13329 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13330 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13331 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13332 cannot be forced from the request.
13333
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013334 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013335 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13336 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13337
13338 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13339 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013340
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013341use-fcgi-app <name>
13342 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13344 no | no | yes | yes
13345 Arguments :
13346 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13347
13348 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013349
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013350use-server <server> if <condition>
13351use-server <server> unless <condition>
13352 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13354 no | no | yes | yes
13355 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013356 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13357 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013358
13359 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13360
13361 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13362 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13363 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13364
13365 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13366 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13367 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13368 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13369 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13370 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13371 matches will assign the server.
13372
13373 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13374 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13375 with the next rules until one matches.
13376
13377 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13378 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13379 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13380 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13381
13382 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13383 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13384 stripped.
13385
13386 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13387 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013388 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013389 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013390 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013391
13392 Example :
13393 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013394 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013395 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013396 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013397 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013398 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013399 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013400 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13401 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13402
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013403 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13404 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13405 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13406 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013407 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013408 and we fall back to load balancing.
13409
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013410 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013411
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013412
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134135. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013414--------------------------
13415
13416The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13417depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13418settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13419written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13420described in this section.
13421
13422
134235.1. Bind options
13424-----------------
13425
13426The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13427as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13428no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13429parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13430while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13431provided immediately after the setting name.
13432
13433The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13434
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013435accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13436 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13437 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13438 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13439 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13440 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13441 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13442 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13443 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13444 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013445 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13446 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13447 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013448
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013449accept-proxy
13450 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013451 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13452 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013453 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13454 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13455 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13456 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013457 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013458 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13459 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013460 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13461 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013462
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013463allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013464 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013465 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013466 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013467 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13468 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013469
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013470alpn <protocols>
13471 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13472 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13473 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013474 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013475 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013476 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13477 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13478 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13479 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13480 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13481 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13482 preference, like below :
13483
13484 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013485
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013486backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013487 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013488 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13489
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013490curves <curves>
13491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13492 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13493 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13494 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13495 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13496 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13497
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013498ecdhe <named curve>
13499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013500 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13501 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013502
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013503ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13505 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13506 client's certificate.
13507
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013508ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13510 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13511 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13512 error is ignored.
13513
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013514ca-sign-file <cafile>
13515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13516 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13517 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13518 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13519 'generate-certificates' for details.
13520
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013521ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13523 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13524 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13525 'generate-certificates' for details.
13526
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013527ca-verify-file <cafile>
13528 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13529 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13530 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13531 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13532 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13533
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013534ciphers <ciphers>
13535 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13536 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013537 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013538 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013539 information and recommendations see e.g.
13540 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13541 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13542 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13543
13544ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13546 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
William Lallemanda088aa02024-02-29 18:04:12 +010013547 the list of cipher algorithms in "cipher suite" format that are negotiated
13548 during the TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1
13549 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher
13550 configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier using the "OpenSSL" ciphers format,
13551 please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013552
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013553crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013554 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13555 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013556 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13557 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013558
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013559crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13561 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13562 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13563 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13564 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013565 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13566 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013567
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013568 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13569 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13570
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013571 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13572 are loaded.
13573
13574 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013575 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13576 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13577 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13578 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13579 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13580 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13581 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013582 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used,
13583 HAProxy will not start unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013584
13585 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13586 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13587 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13588 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013589 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13590 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013591
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013592 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013593
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013594 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013595 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013596 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13597 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013598 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13599 clients).
13600
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013601 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013602 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13603 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13604 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13605 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13606 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13607 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13608 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13609 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13610 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13611 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13612 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13613 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13614
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013615 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013616 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13617 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13618 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13619 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13620
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013621 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13622 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13623 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13624 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013625
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013626 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13627 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13628 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013629
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013630crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013631 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013632 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013633 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013634 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013635
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013636crt-list <file>
13637 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013638 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13639 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013640
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013641 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13642
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013643 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13644 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13645 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13646 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13647 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013648
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013649 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013650 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13651 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13652 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13653 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13654 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013655 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13656 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13657 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013658
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013659 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13660 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13661 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013662
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013663 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13664
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013665 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013666 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013667 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13668 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13669 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13670 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13671 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13672 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013673
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013674 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013675 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013676 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013677 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013678 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013679 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013680
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013681defer-accept
13682 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13683 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13684 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013685 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013686 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13687 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13688 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13689 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13690 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13691 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13692 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13693
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013694expose-fd listeners
13695 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13696 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013697 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13698 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013699 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013700
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013701force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013702 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013703 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013704 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013705 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013706
13707force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013708 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013709 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013710 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013711
13712force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013713 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013714 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013715 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013716
13717force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013718 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013719 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013720 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013721
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013722force-tlsv13
13723 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13724 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013725 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013726
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013727generate-certificates
13728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13729 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13730 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13731 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13732 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13733 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13734 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13735 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13736 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13737 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13738 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13739
13740 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13741 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013742 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013743 certificate is used many times.
13744
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013745gid <gid>
13746 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13747 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13748 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13749 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13750 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13751
13752group <group>
13753 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13754 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13755 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13756 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13757 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13758
13759id <id>
13760 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13761 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13762 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13763 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13764
13765interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013766 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13767 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13768 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13769 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13770 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13771 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013772 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13773 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13774 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13775 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13776 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13777 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013778
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013779level <level>
13780 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13781 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13782 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013783 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013784 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13785 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13786 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013787 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013788 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013789 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013790 all counters).
13791
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013792severity-output <format>
13793 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13794 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13795 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13796 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13797 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13798 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13799 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13800 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13801 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13802 rfc5424 convention.
13803
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013804maxconn <maxconn>
13805 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13806 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13807 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13808 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13809 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13810 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13811 eat all memory.
13812
13813mode <mode>
13814 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13815 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13816 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13817 UNIX sockets.
13818
13819mss <maxseg>
13820 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13821 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13822 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13823 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13824 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13825 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13826 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13827 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13828 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13829 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13830 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13831
13832name <name>
13833 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13834 page.
13835
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013836namespace <name>
13837 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13838 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13839 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13840 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13841
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013842nice <nice>
13843 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13844 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13845 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13846 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13847 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13848 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13849 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13850 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13851 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13852 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13853 one for an RDP socket.
13854
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013855no-ca-names
13856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13857 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013858 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013859
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013860no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013862 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013863 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013864 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013865 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13866 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013867
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013868no-tls-tickets
13869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13870 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13871 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013872 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13873 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013874 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13875 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13876 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013877
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013878no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013880 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013881 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013882 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013883 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13884 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013885
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013886no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013888 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013889 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013890 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013891 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13892 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013893
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013894no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013895 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013896 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013897 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013898 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013899 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13900 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013901
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013902no-tlsv13
13903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13904 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13905 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13906 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013907 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13908 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013909
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013910npn <protocols>
13911 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13912 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13913 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013914 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013915 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013916 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13917 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13918 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13919 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13920 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013921
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013922prefer-client-ciphers
13923 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13924 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13925 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013926 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13927 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13928 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013929
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013930process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013931 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013932 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013933 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013934 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13935 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13936 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13937 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013938 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013939 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13940 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13941 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13942 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13943 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013944
13945 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13946
13947 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13948 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13949 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13950 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13951 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13952 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13953 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13954 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013955
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013956proto <name>
13957 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13958 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13959 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013960 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13961 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13962
13963 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13964 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13965 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13966 also reported (flag=HTX).
13967
13968 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13969 a bind line :
13970
13971 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13972 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13973 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13974
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013975 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013976 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013977 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013978 h2" on the bind line.
13979
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013980ssl
13981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013982 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013983 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13984 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013985 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13986 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013987
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013988ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13989 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013990 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13991 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13992 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013993 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13994
13995ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013996 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13997 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13998 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13999 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014000
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014001strict-sni
14002 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14003 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020014004 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
14005 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
14006 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
14007 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
14008 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014009
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014010tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014011 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014012 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014013 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014014 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014015 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14016 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14017 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14018 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14019 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14020 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14021 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14022
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014023tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014024 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014025 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14026 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14027 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14028 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14029 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14030 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14031 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014032 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14033 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14034 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014035
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014036tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14037 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014038 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14039 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14040 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14041 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14042 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14043 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14044 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14045 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14046 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14047 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014048 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14049 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14050
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014051transparent
14052 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14053 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14054 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14055 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14056 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14057 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14058 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14059 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14060 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14061 so check for support with your vendor.
14062
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014063v4v6
14064 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14065 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14066 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14067 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014068 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014069
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014070v6only
14071 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14072 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14073 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014074 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14075 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014077uid <uid>
14078 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14079 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14080 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14081 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14082 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14083
14084user <user>
14085 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14086 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14087 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14088 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14089 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14090
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014091verify [none|optional|required]
14092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14093 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14094 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14095 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14096 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014097 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14098 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14099 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14100 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014101
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200141025.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014103------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014105The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14106which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14107arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14108settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14109after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14110Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14111address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014113 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014114 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014115
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014116Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14117keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014119The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014120
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014121addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014122 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014123 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14124 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14125 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14126 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14127 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014128
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014129agent-check
14130 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014131 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014132 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14133 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14134 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014135
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014136 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014137 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014138 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014139 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14140 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014142 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14143 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14144 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14145 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14146 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014147
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014148 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014149 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014150
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014151 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14152 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14153 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014154
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014155 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14156 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14157 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014158
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014159 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014160 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14161 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14162 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14163 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014164 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014165 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014166
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014167 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14168 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014169
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014170 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14171 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14172 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14173 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14174 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14175 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14176 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14177 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14178 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014179
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014180 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14181 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014182 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14183 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14184 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014185 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014186
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014187 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014188 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014189
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014190agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014191 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014192 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14193 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14194 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14195 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14196
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014197agent-inter <delay>
14198 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14199 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14200
14201 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14202 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14203 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14204 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14205 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14206 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14207 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14208 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14209 of backends use the same servers.
14210
14211 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14212
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014213agent-addr <addr>
14214 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14215
14216 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014217 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014218 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14219 hostname, it will be resolved.
14220
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014221agent-port <port>
14222 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14223
14224 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14225
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014226allow-0rtt
14227 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014228 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14229 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014230
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014231alpn <protocols>
14232 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14233 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14234 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014235 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014236 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14237 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14238 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14239 now obsolete NPN extension.
14240 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14241 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14242
14243 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14244
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014245 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014247backup
14248 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14249 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14250 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14251 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014252 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14253 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014254
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014255ca-file <cafile>
14256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14257 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14258 server's certificate.
14259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014260check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014261 This option enables health checks on a server:
14262 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14263 considered available.
14264 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14265 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14266 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14267 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14268 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14269 set.
14270 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14271 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14272 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14273 exchanges succeed.
14274
14275 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14276 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14277 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14278 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14279 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014280 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014281 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14282
14283 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14284 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14285
14286 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14287 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14288
14289 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14290 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14291 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14292 available.
14293
14294 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14295 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14296 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14297
14298 Example:
14299 # simple tcp check
14300 backend foo
14301 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14302 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14303 backend foo
14304 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14305 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14306 backend foo
14307 option tcp-check
14308 tcp-check connect
14309 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014310
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014311check-send-proxy
14312 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14313 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14314 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14315 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14316 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14317 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14318 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14319
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014320check-alpn <protocols>
14321 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14322 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14323 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14324
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014325check-proto <name>
14326 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14327 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14328 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014329 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14330 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14331
14332 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14333 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14334 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14335 also reported (flag=HTX).
14336
14337 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14338 directive on a server line:
14339
14340 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14341 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14342 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14343 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14344
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014345 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014346 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14347 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14348
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014349check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014350 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014351 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14352 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014353
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014354check-ssl
14355 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14356 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14357 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14358 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014359 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014360 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14361 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014362 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014363 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14364 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014365
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014366check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014367 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014368 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14369 for normal traffic.
14370
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014371ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14373 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14374 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014375 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14376 information and recommendations see e.g.
14377 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14378 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14379 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014380
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014381ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14382 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14383 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
William Lallemanda088aa02024-02-29 18:04:12 +010014384 describing the list of cipher algorithms in "cipher suite" format that is
14385 negotiated during the TLS handshake with the server. The format of the string
14386 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites"
14387 section. For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier using the "OpenSSL"
14388 cipher format, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014390cookie <value>
14391 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14392 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14393 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14394 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14395 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14396 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14397 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14398
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014399crl-file <crlfile>
14400 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14401 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14402 to verify server's certificate.
14403
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014404crt <cert>
14405 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14406 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14407 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14408 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14409 certificate request.
14410
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014411 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14412 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14413 option is set accordingly).
14414
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014415disabled
14416 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14417 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14418 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14419 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14420 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014421 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014422
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014423enabled
14424 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14425 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14426 default value.
14427 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14428 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014430error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014431 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14432 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14433 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014435 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014437fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014438 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14439 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14440 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14441
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014442force-sslv3
14443 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14444 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014445 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014446 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014447
14448force-tlsv10
14449 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014450 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014451 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014452
14453force-tlsv11
14454 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014455 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014456 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014457
14458force-tlsv12
14459 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014460 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014461 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014462
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014463force-tlsv13
14464 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14465 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014466 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014468id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014469 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14470 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14471 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014472
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014473init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14474 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14475 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014476 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014477 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14478 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14479 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14480 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14481 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14482 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14483 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14484 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14485 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014486 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014487 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14488 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14489 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14490 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14491 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14492 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014493 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014494
14495 Example:
14496 defaults
14497 # never fail on address resolution
14498 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014500inter <delay>
14501fastinter <delay>
14502downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014503 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14504 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14505 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14506 between checks depending on the server state :
14507
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014508 Server state | Interval used
14509 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14510 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14511 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14512 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14513 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14514 or yet unchecked. |
14515 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14516 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14517 | "inter" otherwise.
14518 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014520 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14521 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14522 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14523 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014524 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14525 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14526 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14527 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14528 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014529
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014530log-proto <logproto>
14531 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14532 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14533 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14534 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014536maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014537 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14538 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014539 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14540 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014541 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14542 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14543 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14544 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14545
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014546 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14547 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14548 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14549 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14550 than 50 concurrent requests.
14551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014552maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014553 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14554 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14555 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14556 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014557 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14558 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14559 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14560 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14561 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14562 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14563 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014564
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014565max-reuse <count>
14566 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14567 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14568 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14569 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14570 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14571 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14572 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14573 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014575minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014576 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14577 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14578 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14579 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14580 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14581 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014582 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014583 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014584
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014585namespace <name>
14586 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14587 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14588 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14589 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14590
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014591no-agent-check
14592 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14593 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14594 default value.
14595 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14596 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14597
14598no-backup
14599 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14600 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14601 default value.
14602 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14603 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14604
14605no-check
14606 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14607 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14608 default value.
14609 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14610 "default-server" "check" setting.
14611
14612no-check-ssl
14613 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14614 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14615 default value.
14616 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14617 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14618
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014619no-send-proxy
14620 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14621 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14622 default value.
14623 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14624 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14625
14626no-send-proxy-v2
14627 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14628 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14629 default value.
14630 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14631 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14632
14633no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14634 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14635 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14636 default value.
14637 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14638 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14639
14640no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14641 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14642 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14643 default value.
14644 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14645 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14646
14647no-ssl
14648 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14649 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14650 default value.
14651 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14652 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14653
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014654 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14655 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14656 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14657
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014658no-ssl-reuse
14659 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14660 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14661 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14662 and for paranoid users.
14663
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014664no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014665 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14666 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014667 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014668
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014669 Supported in default-server: No
14670
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014671no-tls-tickets
14672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14673 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14674 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014675 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14676 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014677 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14678 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14679 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014680 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014681
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014682no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014683 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014684 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14685 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014686 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14687 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014688 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014689
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014690 Supported in default-server: No
14691
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014692no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014693 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014694 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14695 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014696 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14697 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014698 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014699
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014700 Supported in default-server: No
14701
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014702no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014703 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014704 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14705 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014706 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14707 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014708 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014709
14710 Supported in default-server: No
14711
14712no-tlsv13
14713 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14714 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14715 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14716 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14717 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014718 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014719
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014720 Supported in default-server: No
14721
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014722no-verifyhost
14723 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14724 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14725 default value.
14726 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14727 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014728
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014729no-tfo
14730 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14731 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14732 default value.
14733 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14734 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14735
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014736non-stick
14737 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14738 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14739 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14740
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014741npn <protocols>
14742 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14743 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14744 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014745 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014746 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14747 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14748 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014750observe <mode>
14751 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14752 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14753 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14754 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14755 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14756 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014757 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014758
14759 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14760
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014761on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014762 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14763 Currently, four modes are available:
14764 - fastinter: force fastinter
14765 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14766 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14767 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14768 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14769
14770 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14771
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014772on-marked-down <action>
14773 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14774 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014775 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14776 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14777 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14778 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14779 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14780 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14781 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14782 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014783
14784 Actions are disabled by default
14785
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014786on-marked-up <action>
14787 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14788 Currently one action is available:
14789 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14790 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14791 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14792 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014793 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14794 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014795 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14796 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14797
14798 Actions are disabled by default
14799
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014800pool-low-conn <max>
14801 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14802 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14803 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14804 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14805 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14806 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14807 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14808 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14809 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14810 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014811 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14812 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14813 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14814 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014815
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014816pool-max-conn <max>
14817 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14818 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14819 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14820 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14821 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14822 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14823
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014824pool-purge-delay <delay>
14825 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014826 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014827 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014829port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014830 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014831 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14832 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14833 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14834 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14835 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014836
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014837proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014838 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14839 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14840 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014841 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14842 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14843
14844 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14845 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14846 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14847 also reported (flag=HTX).
14848
14849 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14850 a server line :
14851
14852 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14853 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14854 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14855 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14856
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014857 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014858 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14859
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014860 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014862redir <prefix>
14863 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14864 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14865 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14866 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14867 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14868 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14869 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14870 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014871 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014872 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014873 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14874 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14875 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14876 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14877
14878 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014880rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014881 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14882 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14883 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14884
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014885resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14886 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14887 server.
14888
14889 Available options:
14890
14891 * allow-dup-ip
14892 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14893 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14894 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14895 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14896 For such case, simply enable this option.
14897 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14898
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014899 * ignore-weight
14900 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14901 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14902 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14903
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014904 * prevent-dup-ip
14905 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14906 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14907 same fqdn.
14908 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14909
14910 Example:
14911 backend b_myapp
14912 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14913 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14914 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14915
14916 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14917 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14918 it
14919 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14920 different address
14921
14922 Default value: not set
14923
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014924resolve-prefer <family>
14925 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14926 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14927 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14928 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14929
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014930 Default value: ipv6
14931
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014932 Example:
14933
14934 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014935
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014936resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014937 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014938 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014939 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014940 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14941 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014942 configured network, another address is selected.
14943
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014944 Example:
14945
14946 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014947
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014948resolvers <id>
14949 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14950 hostname.
14951
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014952 Example:
14953
14954 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014955
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014956 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014957
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014958send-proxy
14959 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14960 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14961 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14962 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014963 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14964 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14965 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14966 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014967 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014968 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14969 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14970 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14971 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14972 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014973 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14974 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014975
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014976send-proxy-v2
14977 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14978 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14979 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14980 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014981 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14982 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14983 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14984 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014985
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014986proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014987 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14988 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14989
14990 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14991 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14992 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14993 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14994 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14995 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14996 connection is supported).
14997 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14998 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14999 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15000 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15001 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15002 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15003 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015004
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015005send-proxy-v2-ssl
15006 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15007 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15008 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15009 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15010 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15011 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15012 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015013 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15014 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015015
15016send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15017 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15018 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15019 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15020 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15021 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15022 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15023 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15024 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015025 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15026 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015028slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015029 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15030 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15031 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15032 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15033 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15034 parameters :
15035
15036 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15037 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15038
15039 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15040 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15041 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15042 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15043
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015044 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015045 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15046 seen as failed.
15047
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015048sni <expression>
15049 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15050 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15051 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015052 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15053 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15054 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15055 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015056 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015057 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015058 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15059 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015060
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015061source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015062source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015063source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015064 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15065 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15066 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15067 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15068
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015069 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15070 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15071 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15072 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15073 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15074 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15075 server.
15076
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015077 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15078 specifying the source address without port(s).
15079
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015080ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015081 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15082 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15083 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15084 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15085 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15086 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015087 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15088 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015089
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015090ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15091 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15092 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15093 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15094
15095ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15096 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15097 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15098 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15099
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015100ssl-reuse
15101 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15102 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15103 default value.
15104 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15105 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15106
15107stick
15108 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15109 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15110 default value.
15111 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15112 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015113
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015114socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015115 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015116 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15117 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15118
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015119tcp-ut <delay>
15120 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015121 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015122 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015123 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015124 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15125 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15126 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15127 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15128 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15129 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15130 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15131 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15132 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15133
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015134tfo
15135 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15136 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15137 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15138 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015139 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015140 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015141
Willy Tarreau42bd5cb2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010015142track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015143 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15144 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15145 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreau42bd5cb2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010015146 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015147 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15148
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015149tls-tickets
15150 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15151 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15152 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015153 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15154 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15155 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015156 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015157 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015158
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015159verify [none|required]
15160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015161 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015162 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15163 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015164 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015165 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15166 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15167 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15168 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15169 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15170 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15171 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15172 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015173
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015174verifyhost <hostname>
15175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015176 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15177 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15178 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15179 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15180 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15181 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15182 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15183 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015184
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015185weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015186 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15187 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15188 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015189 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15190 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15191 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15192 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15193 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15194 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015195
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015196ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15197 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15198 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15199 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15200
15201 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15202 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15203 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15204 server ALPN contains it.
15205
15206 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15207 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15208 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15209 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15210
15211 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15212 favor of the ALPN extension.
15213
15214 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015216
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152175.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15218-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015219
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015220HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15221using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015222configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015223This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15224can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15225workload.
15226This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15227resolution at run time.
15228Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15229carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15230
15231
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152325.3.1. Global overview
15233----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015234
15235As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15236different steps of the process life:
15237
15238 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15239 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15240 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15241
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015242 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15243 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015244
15245A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15246 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15247 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15248 resolution to know this new IP.
15249
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015250When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015251HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015252SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15253from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015254will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015255will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015256
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015257A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015258 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015259 first valid response.
15260
15261 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15262 servers return an error.
15263
15264
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152655.3.2. The resolvers section
15266----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015267
15268This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015269HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15270contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015271
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015272When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15273uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15274is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15275answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15276
15277When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015278used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015279
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015280 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15281 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15282 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015283
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015284 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15285 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015286
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015287 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015288 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15289 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015290
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015291For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15292following scenarios are possible:
15293
15294 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15295 ignored
15296
15297 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15298 applied
15299
15300 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15301 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15302
15303 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15304 retries the query with a new type
15305
15306 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15307 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015308
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015309As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015310a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015311<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015312
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015313
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015314resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015315 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015316
15317A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15318
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015319accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015320 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015321 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015322 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15323 by RFC 6891)
15324
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015325 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15326 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15327 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15328 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15329 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15330 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015331
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015332nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15333 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15334 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15335 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15336 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15337 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15338 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15339 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15340 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15341 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015342 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15343
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015344parse-resolv-conf
15345 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15346 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15347 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15348
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015349hold <status> <period>
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015350 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
15351 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
15352 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
15353 counteract the just received invalid status.
15354
15355 <status> : last name resolution status.
15356 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
15357 status during the concluding period.
15358
15359 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
15360 status during the concluding period.
15361
15362 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
15363 valid status during the concluding period.
15364
15365 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
15366 valid status during the concluding period.
15367
15368 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
15369 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
15370 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
15371 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
15372 dynamic resolution of servers.
15373
15374 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
15375 records after an updated answer record is received. It
15376 applies to SRV records.
15377
15378 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
15379 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
15380 milliseconds by default.
15381
15382 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
15383 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
15384 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
15385 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
15386 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
15387
15388 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
15389 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
15390 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
15391 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
15392
15393 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
15394 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015395
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015396 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015397
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015398resolve_retries <nb>
15399 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15400 giving up.
15401 Default value: 3
15402
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015403 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15404 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15405 type.
15406
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015407timeout <event> <time>
15408 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15409 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15410 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015411 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15412 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015413 Default value: 1s
15414 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015415 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015416 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015417 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15418 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15419
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015420 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015421
15422 resolvers mydns
15423 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15424 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015425 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015426 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015427 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015428 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015429 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015430 hold other 30s
15431 hold refused 30s
15432 hold nx 30s
15433 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015434 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015435 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015436
15437
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200154386. Cache
15439---------
15440
15441HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15442(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15443RAM.
15444
15445The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15446this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15447
15448If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15449independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15450when we try to allocate a new one.
15451
15452The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15453
15454It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15455"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15456for more details.
15457
15458When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15459replaced by "<CACHE>".
15460
15461
154626.1. Limitation
15463----------------
15464
15465The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15466
15467- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015468- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15469 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15470 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015471- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15472- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015473- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15474 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15475 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015476- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15477 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015478- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15479 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15480 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015481
15482- If the request is not a GET
15483- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15484- If the request contains an Authorization header
15485
15486
154876.2. Setup
15488-----------
15489
15490To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15491the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15492
15493
154946.2.1. Cache section
15495---------------------
15496
15497cache <name>
15498 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15499 size of cache is mandatory.
15500
15501total-max-size <megabytes>
15502 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15503 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15504
15505max-object-size <bytes>
15506 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15507 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15508 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15509
15510max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015511 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015512 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15513 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15514 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15515 default.
15516
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015517process-vary <on/off>
15518 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015519 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15520 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15521 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015522 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015523
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015524max-secondary-entries <number>
15525 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15526 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15527 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15528
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015529
155306.2.2. Proxy section
15531---------------------
15532
15533http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15534 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15535 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15536 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15537 after this one.
15538
15539http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15540 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15541 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15542 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15543 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15544
15545
15546Example:
15547
15548 backend bck1
15549 mode http
15550
15551 http-request cache-use foobar
15552 http-response cache-store foobar
15553 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15554
15555 cache foobar
15556 total-max-size 4
15557 max-age 240
15558
15559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155607. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15561----------------------------------
15562
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015563HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15565The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15566these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15567but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15568data called patterns.
15569
15570
155717.1. ACL basics
15572---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015573
15574The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15575content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15576from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15577simple :
15578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015580 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15582 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15585adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015586
15587In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015590
15591This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15592Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15593and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015594an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15595conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15596as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15597are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015598
15599ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15600'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15601which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15602
15603There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15604performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15607specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15608this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015609methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15610ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015611
15612Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15613 - boolean
15614 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15615 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15616 - string
15617 - data block
15618
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015619Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15620converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15621would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15622The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15623which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15624
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015625Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15626keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15627fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15628which are summarized in the table below :
15629
15630 +---------------------+-----------------+
15631 | Sample or converter | Default |
15632 | output type | matching method |
15633 +---------------------+-----------------+
15634 | boolean | bool |
15635 +---------------------+-----------------+
15636 | integer | int |
15637 +---------------------+-----------------+
15638 | ip | ip |
15639 +---------------------+-----------------+
15640 | string | str |
15641 +---------------------+-----------------+
15642 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15643 +---------------------+-----------------+
15644
15645Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15646matching method, see below.
15647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15649 - boolean
15650 - integer or integer range
15651 - IP address / network
15652 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15653 - regular expression
15654 - hex block
15655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015656The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15657
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015658 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15659 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015661 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015662 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015663 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015664 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15667read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15668if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15669lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15670will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15671beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015672a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15674exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15675
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015676The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15677parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15678ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15679a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15680check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15681
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015682The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15683socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15684file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15687loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15688
15689 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15690
15691In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15692the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15693case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15694as well.
15695
15696The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15697sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15698do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15699methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15700is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015701obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15703default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15704that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15705string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15706
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015707The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15708By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15709string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15710resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015711server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015712waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015713flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15714function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15717sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15718be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015719
15720 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15721 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15723 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15724 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15725 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015726
15727 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15728 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015730
15731 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015733
15734 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015735 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015736
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015737 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015738 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15739
15740 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15741 binary or string samples.
15742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15744 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15747 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15748 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015750 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15751 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15754 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015756 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15757 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15760 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015761 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15764 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15765 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015766
15767For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15768request, it is possible to do :
15769
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015770 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015771
15772In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15773buffer, one would use the following acl :
15774
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015775 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015776
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015777On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15778possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15779
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015780 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015782All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15783criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15784method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreauedbeab12022-11-25 10:49:41 +010015785to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
15786usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
15787converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
15788method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
15789matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15791the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015794the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15795For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15798 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15799 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15800 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015801
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015802
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015803The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15804types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15805combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15806brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15807default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015809 +-------------------------------------------------+
15810 | Input sample type |
15811 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015812 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15814 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15815 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015816 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015818 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015820 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015822 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015824 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015826 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015828 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015829 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015830 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015832 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015833 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015834 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015836 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15838 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15839 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015840
15841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158427.1.1. Matching booleans
15843------------------------
15844
15845In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15846Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15847When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15848that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15849
15850Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15851return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15852"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15853
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158557.1.2. Matching integers
15856------------------------
15857
15858Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15859enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15860to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15861
15862Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15863matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15864lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015865
15866For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15867unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15868representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15869
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015870As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15871two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15872instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15873ranges and operators.
15874
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015875For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015876operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15877Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15878of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015880Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015881
15882 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15883 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15884 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15885 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15886 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15887
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015888For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015889
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015890 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015891
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015892This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15893
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015894 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015895
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158977.1.3. Matching strings
15898-----------------------
15899
15900String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15901different forms :
15902
15903 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015904 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905
15906 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015907 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908
15909 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15910 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15911
15912 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15913 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15914
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015915 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15916 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
15917 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
15918 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
15919 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
15920 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015922 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15923 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
15924 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
15925 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
15926 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
15927 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
15928 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
15929 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
15930 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
15931 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
15932 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015933
15934String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15935exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15936characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15937string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15938to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015939before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015940
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015941Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15942(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15943Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15944
15945Example:
15946 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15947 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15948
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159507.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15951---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015952
15953Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15954they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15955possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15956passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15957the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015958the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15959match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015960
15961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159627.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15963-------------------------------------
15964
15965It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15966not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15967a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15968to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15969digits may be used upper or lower case.
15970
15971Example :
15972 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015973 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974
15975
159767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15977---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015978
15979IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15980netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15981within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015982host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015983difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15984at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15985does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15986parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015987
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015988The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15989abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15990
15991 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15992 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15993 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15994 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15995 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15996 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15997 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15998 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15999
16000Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16001192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16002
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016003IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16004Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16005trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16006IPv6 patterns.
16007
16008HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16009following situations :
16010 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16011 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16012 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16013 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16014 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16015 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16016 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16017 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16018 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16019 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016021
160227.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16023----------------------------------
16024
16025Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16026combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16027
16028 - AND (implicit)
16029 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16030 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016032A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16037indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016039For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16040"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16041requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16042is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16043
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016044 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016045 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16046 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16047 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016048
16049To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16050and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16051
16052 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16053 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16054 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16055 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16056
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016057 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16059 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16060 use_backend www if host_www
16061
16062It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16063expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16064be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16065the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16066
16067 The following rule :
16068
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016069 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016070 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071
16072 Can also be written that way :
16073
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016074 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075
16076It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16077to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16078simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16079sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16080good use is the following :
16081
16082 With named ACLs :
16083
16084 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16085 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16086 monitor fail if site_dead
16087
16088 With anonymous ACLs :
16089
16090 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16091
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016092See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16093keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094
16095
160967.3. Fetching samples
16097---------------------
16098
16099Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16100against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16101sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16102ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16103of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16104available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16105
16106This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16107Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16108compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16109deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16110
16111The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16112matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16113method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16114indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16115
16116As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16117when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16118mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16119the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16120ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16121
16122Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16123multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16124when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016125incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16126are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16128all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16129
16130Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16131 - name
16132 - name(arg1)
16133 - name(arg1,arg2)
16134
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016135
161367.3.1. Converters
16137-----------------
16138
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016139Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16140of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16141is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16142was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016143has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016144unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16145
16146These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16147sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16148the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016149support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016150
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016151A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16152support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16153supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16154(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16155bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016158
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001615951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16160 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16161 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16162 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16163 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16164 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16165
16166 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016167 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16168 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016169 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16170 frontend http-in
16171 bind *:8081
16172 default_backend servers
16173 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16174 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16175
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016176add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016177 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016178 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016179 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16180 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016181 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016182 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16183 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16184 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16185 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016186 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016187 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016188
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016189aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16190 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16191 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16192 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16193 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16194 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16195 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16196
16197 Example:
16198 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16199 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16200
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016201and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016202 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016203 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016204 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16205 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016206 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016207 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16208 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16209 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16210 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016211 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016212 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016213
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016214b64dec
16215 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16216 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016217 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16218 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016219
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016220base64
16221 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016222 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016223 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16224 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016225
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016226bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016227 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016228 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016229 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016230 presence of a flag).
16231
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016232bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16233 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16234 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016235 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016236
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016237concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16238 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16239 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16240 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16241 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16242 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16243 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16244 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16245 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16246 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16247 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016248 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016249 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016250 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16251 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016252
16253 Example:
16254 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16255 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16256 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016257 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016258 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16259
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016260cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016261 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16262 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016263
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016264crc32([<avalanche>])
16265 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16266 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16267 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16268 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16269 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16270 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16271 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16272 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16273 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16274 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016275 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16276
16277crc32c([<avalanche>])
16278 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16279 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16280 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16281 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16282 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16283 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16284 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16285 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016286
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016287cut_crlf
16288 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16289 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16290 updated.
16291
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016292da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016293 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16294 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16295 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16296 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016297 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016298 configuration language.
16299
16300 Example:
16301 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016302 bind *:8881
16303 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016304 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016305
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016306debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16307 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16308 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16309 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16310 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16311 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16312 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16313 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16314 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16315 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16316 printable sample types.
16317
16318 Example:
16319 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016320
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016321digest(<algorithm>)
16322 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16323 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16324
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016325 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016326 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16327
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016328div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016329 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16330 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016331 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016332 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16333 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016334 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016335 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16336 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16337 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16338 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016339 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016340 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016341
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016342djb2([<avalanche>])
16343 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16344 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16345 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16346 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16347 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16348 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16349 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016350 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16351 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016352
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016353even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016354 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016355 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16356
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016357field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16358 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16359 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16360 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16361 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16362 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16363 fields.
16364
16365 Example :
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010016366 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(4,_) # <empty>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016367 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16368 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16369 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16370 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16371 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016372
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016373fix_is_valid
16374 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16375 Information eXchange):
16376
16377 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16378 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016379 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016380 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016381 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016382 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16383 checksum
16384
16385 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16386 the server can be parsed.
16387
16388 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16389 message, false if not.
16390
16391 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16392
16393 Example:
16394 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16395 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16396
16397fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16398 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16399 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16400 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16401 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016402 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016403 added.
16404
16405 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16406 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16407 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16408 fix_is_valid converter.
16409
16410 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16411
16412 Example:
16413 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16414 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16415 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16416 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16417 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16418
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016419hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016420 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016421 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016422 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016423 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016424
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016425hex2i
16426 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016427 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016428
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016429htonl
16430 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16431 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16432 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16433 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16434
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016435hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016436 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16437 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16438 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16439 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16440
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016441 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016442 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16443
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016444http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016445 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16446 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016447 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16448 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16449 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16450 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16451 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16452 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16453 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16454 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016456iif(<true>,<false>)
16457 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16458 string otherwise.
16459
16460 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016461 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016462
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016463in_table(<table>)
16464 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16465 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16466 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016467 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016468 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16469
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016470ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016471 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016472 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016473 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16474 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16475 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16476 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16477 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016478
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016479json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016480 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016481 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016482 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016483 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16484 of errors:
16485 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16486 bytes, ...)
16487 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16488 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16489
16490 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16491 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16492 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16493 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16494 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16495 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016496 - "ascii" : never fails;
16497 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16498 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016499 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016500 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016501 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16502 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16503
16504 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016505 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016506
16507 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016508 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016509 capture request header user-agent len 150
16510 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016511
16512 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16513 GET / HTTP/1.0
16514 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16515
16516 Output log:
16517 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16518
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016519json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16520 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16521 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16522 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16523 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16524
16525 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16526 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16527
16528 Example:
16529 # get a integer value from the request body
16530 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16531 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16532
16533 # get a key with '.' in the name
16534 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16535 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16536
16537 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16538 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16539
16540 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16541 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016543language(<value>[,<default>])
16544 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16545 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16546 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16547 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16548 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16549 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16550 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16551 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16552 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016553 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016554 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16555 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016556
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016557 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016558
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016559 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16560 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016561
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016562 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16563 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16564 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16565 use_backend spanish if es
16566 use_backend french if fr
16567 use_backend english if en
16568 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016569
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016570length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016571 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16572 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16573 type. The result is of type integer.
16574
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016575lower
16576 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16577 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16578 type. The result is of type string.
16579
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016580ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16581 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16582 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16583 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16584 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16585 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16586 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16587
16588 Example :
16589
16590 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016591 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016592 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16593
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016594ltrim(<chars>)
16595 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16596 representation of the input sample.
16597
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016598map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16599map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16600map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16601 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16602 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16603 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16604 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16605 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16606 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16607 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16608 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016609
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016610 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16611 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16612 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016613
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016614 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016615 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016616
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016617 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16618 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16619 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16620 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016621 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16622 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016623 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16624 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16625 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16626 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16627 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16628 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16629 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16630 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016631 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16632 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16633 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016634 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16635 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16636 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16637 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16638 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016639
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016640 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16641 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16642 the corresponding match text.
16643
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016644 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16645 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16646 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16647 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16648 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016649
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016650 Example :
16651
16652 # this is a comment and is ignored
16653 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16654 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16655 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16656 | | | `---------- value
16657 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16658 | `---------------------------- key
16659 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16660
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016661mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016662 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16663 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016664 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016665 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016666 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016667 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16668 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16669 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16670 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016671 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016672 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016673
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016674mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016675 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16676 <packettype>.
16677 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16678 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16679 from.
16680 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16681 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16682 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16683
16684 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16685 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16686 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16687 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16688
16689 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16690 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16691 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16692 packets only):
16693 17: Session Expiry Interval
16694 33: Receive Maximum
16695 39: Maximum Packet Size
16696 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16697 25: Request Response Information
16698 23: Request Problem Information
16699 21: Authentication Method
16700 22: Authentication Data
16701 18: Will Delay Interval
16702 1: Payload Format Indicator
16703 2: Message Expiry Interval
16704 3: Content Type
16705 8: Response Topic
16706 9: Correlation Data
16707 Not supported yet:
16708 38: User Property
16709
16710 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16711 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16712 packets only):
16713 17: Session Expiry Interval
16714 33: Receive Maximum
16715 36: Maximum QoS
16716 37: Retain Available
16717 39: Maximum Packet Size
16718 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16719 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16720 31: Reason String
16721 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16722 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16723 42: Shared Subscription Available
16724 19: Server Keep Alive
16725 26: Response Information
16726 28: Server Reference
16727 21: Authentication Method
16728 22: Authentication Data
16729 Not supported yet:
16730 38: User Property
16731
16732 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16733 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16734 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16735 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16736
16737 Example:
16738
16739 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16740 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16741 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16742 if data_in_buffer
16743 # do the same as above
16744 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16745 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16746 if data_in_buffer
16747
16748mqtt_is_valid
16749 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16750
16751 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16752 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16753 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16754 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16755
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016756 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16757
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016758 Example:
16759
16760 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016761 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016762
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016763mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016764 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016765 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16766 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016767 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016768 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016769 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016770 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16771 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16772 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16773 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016774 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016775 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016776
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016777nbsrv
16778 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16779 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16780 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16781 map lookup.
16782
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016783neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016784 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16785 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16786 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16787 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016788
16789not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016790 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016791 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016792 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016793 absence of a flag).
16794
16795odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016796 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016797 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16798
16799or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016800 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016801 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016802 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16803 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016804 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016805 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16806 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16807 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16808 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016809 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016810 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016811
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016812protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16813 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16814 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16815 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16816 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16817 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16818 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16819 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16820 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16821 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16822 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16823 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16824
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016825regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016826 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16827 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16828 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16829 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16830 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16831 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16832 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16833 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16834 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016835 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16836 of characters with other ones.
16837
16838 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16839 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16840 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16841 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16842 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16843 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016844
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016845 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016846
16847 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16848 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16849 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016850 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016851
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016852 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16853 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16854
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016855 # capture groups and backreferences
16856 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016857 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016858 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16859
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016860capture-req(<id>)
16861 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16862 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16863
16864 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016865 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16866 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016867
16868capture-res(<id>)
16869 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16870 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16871
16872 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016873 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16874 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016875
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016876rtrim(<chars>)
16877 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16878 of the input sample.
16879
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016880sdbm([<avalanche>])
16881 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16882 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16883 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16884 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16885 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16886 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16887 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016888 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16889 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016890
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016891secure_memcmp(<var>)
16892 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16893 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16894 match.
16895
16896 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16897 performed in constant time.
16898
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016899 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016900 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16901
16902 Example :
16903
16904 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16905 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16906 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16907 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16908
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016909set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016910 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16911 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16912 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016913 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016914 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16915 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016916 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016917 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16918 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016919 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016920 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016921
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016922sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016923 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016924 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16925
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016926sha2([<bits>])
16927 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16928 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16929
16930 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16931 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16932
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016933 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016934 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16935
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016936srv_queue
16937 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16938 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16939 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16940 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16941 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16942
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016943strcmp(<var>)
16944 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16945 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16946 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16947 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16948 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16949 shorter).
16950
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016951 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16952 strings in constant time.
16953
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016954 Example :
16955
16956 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16957 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16958 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16959
16960
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016961sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016962 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16963 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016964 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016965 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16966 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016967 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016968 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16969 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016970 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016971 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16972 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016973 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016974 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016975
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016976table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16979 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16980 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16981 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16982 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16983
16984
16985table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16986 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16987 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16988 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16989 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16990 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16991 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16992
16993table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16994 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16995 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016996 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016997 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16998 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16999
17000table_conn_cur(<table>)
17001 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17002 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17003 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17004 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17005 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17006
17007table_conn_rate(<table>)
17008 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17009 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17010 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17011 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17012 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17013
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017014table_gpt0(<table>)
17015 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17016 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17017 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17018 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17019 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17020
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017021table_gpc0(<table>)
17022 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17023 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17024 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17025 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17026 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17027
17028table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17029 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17030 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17031 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17032 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17033 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17034 sample fetch keyword.
17035
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017036table_gpc1(<table>)
17037 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17038 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17039 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17040 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17041 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17042
17043table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17044 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17045 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17046 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17047 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17048 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17049 sample fetch keyword.
17050
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017051table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17052 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17053 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017054 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017055 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17056 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17057
17058table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17059 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17060 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17061 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17062 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17063 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17064 keyword.
17065
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017066table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17067 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17068 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17069 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17070 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17071 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17072
17073table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17074 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17075 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17076 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17077 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17078 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17079 keyword.
17080
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017081table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17082 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17083 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017084 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017085 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17086 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17087
17088table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17089 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17090 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17091 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17092 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17093 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17094 keyword.
17095
17096table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17097 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17098 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017099 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017100 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17101 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17102 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17103 keyword.
17104
17105table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17106 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17107 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017108 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017109 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17110 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17111 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17112 keyword.
17113
17114table_server_id(<table>)
17115 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17116 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17117 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17118 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17119 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17120 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17121
17122table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17123 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17124 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017125 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017126 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17127 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17128 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17129 keyword.
17130
17131table_sess_rate(<table>)
17132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17135 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17136 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17137 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17138 keyword.
17139
17140table_trackers(<table>)
17141 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17142 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17143 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17144 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17145 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17146 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17147 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17148 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17149 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17150 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17151
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017152ub64dec
17153 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17154 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17155 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17156
17157 Example:
17158 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17159 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17160
17161ub64enc
17162 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17163
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017164upper
17165 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17166 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17167 type. The result is of type string.
17168
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017169url_dec([<in_form>])
17170 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17171 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17172 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17173 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17174 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17175 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017176
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017177url_enc([<enc_type>])
17178 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17179 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17180 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17181 optional argument is here for future changes.
17182
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017183ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017184 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017185 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17186 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17187 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017188 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17189 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17190 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17191 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017192 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017193 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17194 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017195
17196 Example:
17197 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17198 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17199
17200 message Point {
17201 int32 latitude = 1;
17202 int32 longitude = 2;
17203 }
17204
17205 message PPoint {
17206 Point point = 59;
17207 }
17208
17209 message Rectangle {
17210 // One corner of the rectangle.
17211 PPoint lo = 48;
17212 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17213 PPoint hi = 49;
17214 }
17215
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017216 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17217 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17218 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017219
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017220 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17221 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017222 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017223 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17224
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017225 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017226
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017227 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017228
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017229 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17230 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17231 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017232
17233 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17234 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17235 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17236
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017237 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17238 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17239 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017240
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017241
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017242unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017243 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17244 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17245 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17246 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17247 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17248 response),
17249 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17250 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17251 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17252 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17253
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017254utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17255 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17256 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17257 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17258 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17259 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17260 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17261
17262 Example :
17263
17264 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017265 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017266 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17267
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017268word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17269 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17270 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17271 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010017272 Empty words are skipped. This means that delimiters at the start or end of
17273 the input string are ignored and consecutive delimiters within the input
17274 string are considered to be a single delimiter.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017275 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17276 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17277
17278 Example :
17279 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010017280 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(5,_) # <not found>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017281 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17282 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17283 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17284 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017285 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010017286 str(/f1////f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017287
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017288wt6([<avalanche>])
17289 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17290 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17291 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17292 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17293 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17294 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17295 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017296 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17297 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017298
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017299xor(<value>)
17300 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017301 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017302 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017303 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017304 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017305 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17306 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017307 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017308 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17309 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017310 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017311 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017312
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017313xxh3([<seed>])
17314 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17315 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17316 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17317 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17318 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17319 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17320 considered as cryptographically secure.
17321
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017322xxh32([<seed>])
17323 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17324 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17325 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17326 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17327 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17328 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17329 as cryptographically secure.
17330
17331xxh64([<seed>])
17332 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17333 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17334 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17335 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17336 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17337 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17338 as cryptographically secure.
17339
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017340
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173417.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342--------------------------------------------
17343
17344A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17345not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17346"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17347The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17348
17349always_false : boolean
17350 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17351 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17352
17353always_true : boolean
17354 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17355 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17356
17357avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017358 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017359 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17360 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17361 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17362 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17363 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17364 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17365 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17366 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17367 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17368 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17369 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17370 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17371 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017374 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17375 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17376 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17377 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017378 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17379
17380be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17382 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17383 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17384 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17385 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017386 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17387 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017388
17389 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17390 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17391 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017393be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17394 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17395 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17396 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017397 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017398 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17399 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017400
17401 Example :
17402 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17403 backend dynamic
17404 mode http
17405 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17406 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017407
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017408bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017409 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17410 of the string.
17411
17412bool(<bool>) : bool
17413 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17414 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017416connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17417 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017418 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017419 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17420 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017421
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017422 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017423 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017424 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17425
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017426 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17427 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017428
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017429 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017430 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017432 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017433 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017434 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017435 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017436
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017437 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17438 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017440 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017441
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017442cpu_calls : integer
17443 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17444 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17445 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17446 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17447 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17448 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17449
17450cpu_ns_avg : integer
17451 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17452 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17453 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17454 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17455 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17456 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17457 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17458 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17459 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17460 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17461 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17462
17463cpu_ns_tot : integer
17464 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17465 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17466 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17467 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17468 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17469 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17470 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17471 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17472 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17473 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17474 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17475 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17476 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17477
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017478date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017479 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017480
17481 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17482 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17483 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017484 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17485
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017486 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17487 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17488 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17489 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17490 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17491
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017492 Example :
17493
17494 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17495 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017496
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017497 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17498 # millisecond granularity
17499 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17500
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017501date_us : integer
17502 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17503 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17504 from the same timeval structure.
17505
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017506distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17507 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17508 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17509 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17510 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017511 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017512 list of supported tokens.
17513
17514distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17515 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17516 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17517 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17518 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017519 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017520 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17521 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17522 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17523 supported tokens.
17524
17525 Example :
17526 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17527 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17528 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17529 # send large files to the big farm
17530 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17531
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017532env(<name>) : string
17533 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17534 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17535 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17536 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17537 certain way.
17538
17539 Examples :
17540 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17541 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17542
17543 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017544 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17547 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017548 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17549 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017550 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17551 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017552 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17554 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017555
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017556fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17557 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17558 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17559 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17562 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17563 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17564 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17565 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17566 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17567 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17568 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17569 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017570
17571 Example :
17572 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17573 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17574 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17575 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17576 frontend mail
17577 bind :25
17578 mode tcp
17579 maxconn 100
17580 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17581 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17582 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17583 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017584
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017585hostname : string
17586 Returns the system hostname.
17587
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017588int(<integer>) : signed integer
17589 Returns a signed integer.
17590
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017591ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17592 Returns an ipv4.
17593
17594ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17595 Returns an ipv6.
17596
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017597lat_ns_avg : integer
17598 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17599 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17600 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17601 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17602 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17603 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17604 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17605 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17606 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017607 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17608 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17609 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17610 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17611 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17612 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017613
17614lat_ns_tot : integer
17615 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17616 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17617 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17618 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17619 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17620 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17621 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17622 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17623 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017624 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17625 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17626 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17627 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17628 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017629 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17630 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17631 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17632 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17633 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17634 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17635
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017636meth(<method>) : method
17637 Returns a method.
17638
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017639nbproc : integer
17640 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17641 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17642 and debugging purposes.
17643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17646 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17647 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017648 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17649 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17650 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017651
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017652prio_class : integer
17653 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17654 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17655 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17656
17657prio_offset : integer
17658 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17659 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17660 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17661 set-priority-offset".
17662
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017663proc : integer
17664 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17665 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17666 debugging purposes.
17667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017668queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017669 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17670 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17671 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017672 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17673 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17674 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17675 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17676 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17677
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017678rand([<range>]) : integer
17679 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17680 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17681 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17682 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17683 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017685srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17686 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17687 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17688 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17689 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17690 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017691 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17692 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17693
17694srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17695 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17696 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17697 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17698 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17699 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17700 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17701 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17702
17703 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17704 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017705
17706srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17707 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17708 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17709 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017710 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017711 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17712 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17713 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17714
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017715srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17716 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17717 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17718 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17719 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17720 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17721 fetch methods.
17722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017723srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17724 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17725 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017726 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017727 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17728 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017729 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730 overloading servers).
17731
17732 Example :
17733 # Redirect to a separate back
17734 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17735 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17736 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17737
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017738srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017739 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17740 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17741 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17742
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017743srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017744 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17745 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17746 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17747
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017748srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017749 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17750 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17751 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17752
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017753stopping : boolean
17754 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17755 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17756 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17757
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017758str(<string>) : string
17759 Returns a string.
17760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017761table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17762 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17763 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17764
17765table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17766 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17767 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17768 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17769
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017770thread : integer
17771 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17772 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17773 and debugging purposes.
17774
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017775uuid([<version>]) : string
17776 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17777 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17778 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17779
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017780var(<var-name>) : undefined
17781 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017782 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17783 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017784 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017785 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17786 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017787 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017788 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17789 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017790 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017791 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017792
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177937.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017794----------------------------------
17795
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017796The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017797closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17798methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17799sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17800TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017801the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17802counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017803"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17804used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17805can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17806Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17807table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17808tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17809currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017810
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017811bc_dst : ip
17812 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17813 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17814 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17815 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17816
17817bc_dst_port : integer
17818 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017819 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017820
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017821bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017822 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17823 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17824 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17825
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017826bc_src : ip
17827 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017828 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017829 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17830 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17831
17832bc_src_port : integer
17833 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017834 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017836be_id : integer
17837 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017838 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17839 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017840
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017841be_name : string
17842 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017843 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17844 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017845
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017846be_server_timeout : integer
17847 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17848 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17849 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17850
17851be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17852 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17853 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17854 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17855
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017856cur_server_timeout : integer
17857 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17858 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17859 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17860
17861cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17862 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17863 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17864 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017866dst : ip
17867 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17868 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17869 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17870 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017871 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17872 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17873 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17874 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17875 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17876 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017877
17878dst_conn : integer
17879 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17880 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17881 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17882 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17883 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17884 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17885 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17886 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017887
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017888dst_is_local : boolean
17889 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17890 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17891 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17892 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017893 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017894 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17895 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17896 it only once per connection.
17897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017898dst_port : integer
17899 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17900 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17901 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17902 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17903 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17904 an HTTP header.
17905
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017906fc_fackets : integer
17907 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17908 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17909 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17910 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17911
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017912fc_http_major : integer
17913 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17914 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17915 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17916
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017917fc_lost : integer
17918 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17919 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17920 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17921 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17922
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017923fc_pp_authority : string
17924 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17925 if any.
17926
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017927fc_pp_unique_id : string
17928 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17929 if any.
17930
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017931fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17932 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17933 header.
17934
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017935fc_reordering : integer
17936 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17937 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17938 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17939 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17940
17941fc_retrans : integer
17942 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17943 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17944 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17945 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17946
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017947fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17948 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17949 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17950 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17951 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17952 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17953 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17954
17955fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17956 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17957 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17958 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17959 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17960 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17961 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17962
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017963fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017964 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17965 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17966 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17967 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17968
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017969
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017970fc_unacked : integer
17971 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17972 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17973 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17974 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017975
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017976fe_defbe : string
17977 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17978 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017980fe_id : integer
17981 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017982 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017983 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17984
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017985fe_name : string
17986 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17987 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17988 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17989
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017990fe_client_timeout : integer
17991 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17992 current frontend.
17993
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017994sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017995sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17996sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17997sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017998 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17999 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18000 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18001
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018002sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018003sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18004sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18005sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018006 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18007 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18008 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18009
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018010sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018011sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18012sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18013sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018014 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18015 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018016 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18017 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18018 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018019
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018020 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018021 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18022 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018023 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18024 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18025 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018026 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18027 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18028
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018029sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18030sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18031sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18032sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18033 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18034 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18035 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18036 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18037 when a first ACL was verified.
18038
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018039sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018040sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18041sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18042sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018043 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018044 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18045
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018046sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018047sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18048sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18049sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018050 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18051 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18052 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18053
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018054sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018055sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18056sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18057sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018058 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18059 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18060 See also src_conn_rate.
18061
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018062sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018063sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18064sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18065sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018066 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018067 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018068
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018069sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18070sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18071sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18072sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18073 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18074 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18075
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018076sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18077sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18078sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18079sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18080 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18081 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18082
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018083sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018084sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18085sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18086sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018087 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18088 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18089 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018090 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18091 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18092 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018093
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018094sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18095sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18096sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18097sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18098 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18099 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18100 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18101 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18102 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18103 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18104
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018105sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018106sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18107sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18108sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018109 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018110 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18111 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18112
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018113sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018114sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18115sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18116sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018117 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18118 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18119 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18120 src_http_err_rate.
18121
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018122sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18123sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18124sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18125sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18126 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18127 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18128 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18129
18130sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18131sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18132sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18133sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18134 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18135 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18136 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18137 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18138
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018139sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018140sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18141sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18142sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018143 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018144 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18145 src_http_req_cnt.
18146
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018147sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018148sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18149sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18150sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018151 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18152 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18153 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18154 src_http_req_rate.
18155
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018156sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018157sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18158sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18159sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018160 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018161 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18162 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18163 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18164 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018165
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018166 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018167 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18168 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018169 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18170
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018171sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18172sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18173sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18174sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18175 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18176 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18177 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18178 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18179 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18180
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018181sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018182sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18183sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18184sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018185 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18186 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18187 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018189sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018190sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18191sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18192sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018193 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18194 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18195 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018197sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018198sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18199sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18200sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018201 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018202 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18203 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18204 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018205 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018206 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18207
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018208sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018209sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18210sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18211sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018212 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18213 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18214 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18215 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18216 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018217 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018218
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018219sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018220sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18221sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18222sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018223 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18224 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18225 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18226
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018227sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018228sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18229sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18230sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018231 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18232 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018233 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018234 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18235 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018236 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18237 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18238 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018240so_id : integer
18241 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18242 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18243 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018244
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018245so_name : string
18246 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18247 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18248 strings instead of integers.
18249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018250src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018251 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18253 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18254 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018255 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18256 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18257 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018258 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18259 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18260 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18261 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18262 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18263 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18264 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018265
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018266 Example:
18267 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18268 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018270src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18271 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18272 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18273 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018274 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018276src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18277 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18278 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018279 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018280 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018282src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18283 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18284 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18285 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18286 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18287 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18288 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018289
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018290 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018291 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18292 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18293 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18294 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018295 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018296 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18297 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18298
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018299src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18300 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18301 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18302 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18303 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18304 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18305 was verified.
18306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018307src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018308 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018309 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018310 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018311 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018313src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018314 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018315 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18316 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018317 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018319src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18320 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18321 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18322 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018323 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018325src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018326 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018327 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018328 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018329 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018330
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018331src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18332 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18333 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18334 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18335 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18336
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018337src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18338 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18339 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18340 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18341 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018344 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018346 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18347 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018348 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18349 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18350 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018351
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018352src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18353 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18354 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18355 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18356 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18357 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18358 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18359 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018361src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018362 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018363 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018364 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018365 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018368src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18369 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18370 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18371 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18372 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018373 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018374
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018375src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18376 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18377 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018378 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018379 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18380 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18381
18382src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18383 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18384 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18385 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18386 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18387 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18388 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018390src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018391 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018392 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18393 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018394 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018396src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18397 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18398 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18399 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018400 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018401 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018403src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18404 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18405 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18406 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018407 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018408 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18409 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018410
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018411 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018412 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018413 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018414 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018415
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018416src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18417 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18418 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18419 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18420 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18421 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18422 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18423
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018424src_is_local : boolean
18425 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18426 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18427 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18428 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018429 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018430 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18431 once per connection.
18432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018433src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018434 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18435 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18436 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18437 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18438 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018440src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018441 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18442 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18443 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18444 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18445 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018447src_port : integer
18448 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18449 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18450 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18451 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018453src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018454 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018455 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18456 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18457 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018458 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018460src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18461 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18462 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18463 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18464 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018465 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018467src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18468 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18469 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18470 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18471 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18472 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18473 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18474 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18475 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018476
18477 Example :
18478 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18479 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18480 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18481 listen ssh
18482 bind :22
18483 mode tcp
18484 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018485 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018486 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018487 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018489srv_id : integer
18490 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18491 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018492 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018493
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018494srv_name : string
18495 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18496 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018497 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018498
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184997.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018500----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018501
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018502The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018503closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18504when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18505usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018506future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018507
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001850851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18509 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18510 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18511 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18512 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18513 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18514
18515 Example :
18516 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18517 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18518 # the request.
18519 frontend http-in
18520 bind *:8081
18521 default_backend servers
18522 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18523 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18524
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018525ssl_bc : boolean
18526 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18527 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John3d379952023-05-22 13:11:13 -050018528 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018529 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018530
18531ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18532 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018533 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18534 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018535
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018536ssl_bc_alpn : string
18537 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18538 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018539 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018540 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18541 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18542 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18543 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18544 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018545 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18546 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018547
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018548ssl_bc_cipher : string
18549 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018550 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18551 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018552
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018553ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18554 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18555 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18556 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018557 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018558
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018559ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18560 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18561 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018562 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18563 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018564
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018565ssl_bc_npn : string
18566 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18567 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018568 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018569 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18570 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18571 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18572 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018573 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18574 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018575
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018576ssl_bc_protocol : string
18577 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018578 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18579 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018580
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018581ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018582 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018583 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018584 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18585 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018586
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018587ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18588 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18589 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18590 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018591 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018592
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018593ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18594 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18595 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018596 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18597 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018598
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018599ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18600 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18601 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18602 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018603 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018604
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018605ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18606 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018607 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18608 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018610ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18611 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18612 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18613 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18614 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18615 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018617ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18618 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18619 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18620 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18621 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018622
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018623ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018624 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18625 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18626 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018627 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018628 does not support resumed sessions.
18629
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018630ssl_c_der : binary
18631 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18632 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18633 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635ssl_c_err : integer
18636 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18637 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18638 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18639 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18640 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018641
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018642ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018643 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18644 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18645 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18646 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18647 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18648 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18649 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18650 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018651 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18652 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18653 LDAP v3.
18654 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18655 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018657ssl_c_key_alg : string
18658 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18659 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18660 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018662ssl_c_notafter : string
18663 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18664 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18665 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018667ssl_c_notbefore : string
18668 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18669 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18670 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018671
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018672ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018673 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18674 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18675 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18676 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18677 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18678 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18679 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18680 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018681 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18682 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18683 LDAP v3.
18684 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18685 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018687ssl_c_serial : binary
18688 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18689 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18690 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018692ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18693 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18694 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18695 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018696 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18697 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18698
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018699 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018700 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18703 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18704 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18705 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018707ssl_c_used : boolean
18708 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18709 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018711ssl_c_verify : integer
18712 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18713 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18714 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18715 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018717ssl_c_version : integer
18718 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18719 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018720
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018721ssl_f_der : binary
18722 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18723 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18724 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18725
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018726ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018727 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18728 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18729 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18730 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018731 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018732 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18733 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18734 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018735 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18736 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18737 LDAP v3.
18738 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18739 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018741ssl_f_key_alg : string
18742 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18743 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18744 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018746ssl_f_notafter : string
18747 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18748 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18749 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018751ssl_f_notbefore : string
18752 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18753 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18754 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018755
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018756ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018757 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18758 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18759 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18760 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18761 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18762 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18763 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18764 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018765 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18766 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18767 LDAP v3.
18768 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18769 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018771ssl_f_serial : binary
18772 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18773 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18774 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018775
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018776ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18777 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18778 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18779 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018781ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18782 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18783 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18784 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018786ssl_f_version : integer
18787 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18788 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18789
18790ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018791 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18792 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18793 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018795 Example :
18796 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18797 listen http-https
18798 bind :80
18799 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18800 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18801
18802ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18803 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18804 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18805
18806ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018807 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018808 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018809 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018810 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18811 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18812 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18813 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18814 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18815 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018817ssl_fc_cipher : string
18818 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18819 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018820
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018821ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18822 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18823 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018824 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018825
18826ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18827 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18828 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018829 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018830
18831ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18832 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18833 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18834 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018835 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018836 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018837
18838ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18839 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18840 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018841 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018842
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018843ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18844 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18845 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18846 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18847
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018848ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18849 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18850 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18851 transport layer.
18852 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18853 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18854 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18855 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18856
18857ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18858 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18859 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18860 transport layer.
18861 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18862 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18863 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18864 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18865
18866ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18867 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18868 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18869 transport layer.
18870 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18871 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18872 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18873 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18874
18875ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18876 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18877 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18878 transport layer.
18879 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18880 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18881 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18882 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18883
18884ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18885 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18886 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18887 transport layer.
18888 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18889 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18890 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18891 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018893ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018894 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18895 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018896 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18897 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18898 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18899 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018900
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018901ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18902 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18903 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18904 wait until the handshake happened.
18905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018906ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18907 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018908 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18909 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018910 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018911 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018912
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018913ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018914 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018915 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18916 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018918ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018919 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018920 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018921 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18922 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18923 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18924 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18925 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18926 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018928ssl_fc_protocol : string
18929 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18930 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018931
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018932ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018933 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018934 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018935 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018936
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018937ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18938 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18939 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18940 transport layer.
18941 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18942 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18943 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18944 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18945
18946ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18947 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18948 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18949 transport layer.
18950 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18951 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18952 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18953 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18954
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018955ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18956 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18957 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18958 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018960ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18961 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18962 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18963 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18964 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018965
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018966ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18967 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18968 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18969 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18970 BoringSSL.
18971
18972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018973ssl_fc_sni : string
18974 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18975 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018976 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018977 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18978 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18979
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018980 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018981 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018982 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018983 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018984 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018985
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010018986 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
18987 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
18988 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
18989 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
18990 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
18991 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
18992 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
18993 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
18994 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
18995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018996 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018997 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18998 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019000ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19001 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19002 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019003
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019004ssl_s_der : binary
19005 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19006 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19007 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19008
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019009ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19010 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19011 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19012 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019013 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019014 does not support resumed sessions.
19015
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019016ssl_s_key_alg : string
19017 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19018 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19019 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19020
19021ssl_s_notafter : string
19022 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19023 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19024 transport layer.
19025
19026ssl_s_notbefore : string
19027 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19028 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19029 transport layer.
19030
19031ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19032 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19033 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19034 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19035 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19036 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19037 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019038 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19039 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019040 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19041 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19042 LDAP v3.
19043 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19044 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19045
19046ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19047 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19048 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19049 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19050 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19051 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19052 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019053 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19054 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019055 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19056 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19057 LDAP v3.
19058 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19059 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19060
19061ssl_s_serial : binary
19062 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19063 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19064 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19065
19066ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19067 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19068 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19069 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19070
19071ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19072 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19073 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19074 layer.
19075
19076ssl_s_version : integer
19077 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19078 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019079
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190807.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019081------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019083Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19084sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19085only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19086For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19087be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19088can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19089sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19090for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19091content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019092
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019093Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19094 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019095 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019096 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19097 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19098 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19099 sample expression). So be careful.
19100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019102 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019103 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19104 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019106payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19107 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019108 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019109 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019111req.len : integer
19112req_len : integer (deprecated)
19113 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19114 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19115 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19116 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19117 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019118 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019119 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19120 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019122req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19123 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019124 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19125 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19126 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19127 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019128
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019129 ACL derivatives :
19130 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019132req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19133 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19134 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19135 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19136 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019137
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019138 ACL derivatives :
19139 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019141 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143req.proto_http : boolean
19144req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19145 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19146 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19147 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19148 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19149 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19150 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19151 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019153 Example:
19154 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19155 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19156 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019157 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019159req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19160rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19161 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19162 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19163 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19164 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19165 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19166 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19167 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019169 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19170 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19171 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19172 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19173 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19174 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019176 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019177 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019179 Example :
19180 listen tse-farm
19181 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19182 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19183 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19184 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19185 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19186 persist rdp-cookie
19187 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19188 # This is only useful makes sense if
19189 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19190 stick-table type string size 204800
19191 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19192 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19193 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019195 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019196 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019198req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19199rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19200 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19201 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19202 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19203 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019205 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019206 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019207
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019208req.ssl_alpn : string
19209 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19210 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19211 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19212 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19213 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19214 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019215 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019216
19217 Examples :
19218 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19219 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019220 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019221 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019222 default_backend bk_default
19223
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019224req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19225 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19226 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019227 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19228 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19229 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19230 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19231 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019233req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19234req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19235 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19236 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19237 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19238 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19239 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19240 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19241 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019243req.ssl_sni : string
19244req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19245 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19246 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19247 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19248 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19249 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019250 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19251 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19252 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19253 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19254 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19255 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19256 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19257 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19258 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019260 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019261 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019263 Examples :
19264 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19265 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019266 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019267 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019269
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019270req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19271 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19272 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19273 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19274 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19275 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19276 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19277 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19278 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19279 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019281req.ssl_ver : integer
19282req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19283 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19284 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19285 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19286 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19287 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19288 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19289 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019290 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019291 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019293 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019294 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019295
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019296res.len : integer
19297 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19298 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19299 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19300 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19301 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019302 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019303 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019304 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019306res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19307 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019308 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019309 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019310 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019311 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019313res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19314 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19315 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19316 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019317 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19318 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019320 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019321
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019322res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19323rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19324 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19325 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19326 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19327 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19328 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19329 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19330 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019332wait_end : boolean
19333 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19334 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019335 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019336 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19337 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019338 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019339 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19340 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019342 Examples :
19343 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19344 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19345 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019347 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19348 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19349 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19350 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19351 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19352 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19353 tcp-request content reject
19354
19355
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193567.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019357--------------------------------------
19358
19359It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19360This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19361data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19362its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19363HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19364content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19365to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19366more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19367response are indexed.
19368
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019369Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19370 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19371 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19372 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19373 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19374 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19375 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019377base : string
19378 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19379 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19380 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19381 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19382 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19383 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19384 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19385 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19386
19387 ACL derivatives :
19388 base : exact string match
19389 base_beg : prefix match
19390 base_dir : subdir match
19391 base_dom : domain match
19392 base_end : suffix match
19393 base_len : length match
19394 base_reg : regex match
19395 base_sub : substring match
19396
19397base32 : integer
19398 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19399 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19400 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019401 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19402 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19403 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019404
19405base32+src : binary
19406 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19407 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19408 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19409 per-URL counters.
19410
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019411baseq : string
19412 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19413 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19414 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19415 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19416
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019417capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19418 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19419 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19420 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19421
19422capture.req.method : string
19423 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19424 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19425 because it's allocated.
19426
19427capture.req.uri : string
19428 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19429 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19430 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19431 allocated.
19432
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019433capture.req.ver : string
19434 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19435 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19436 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19437
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019438capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19439 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19440 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19441 The first entry is an index of 0.
19442 See also: "capture response header"
19443
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019444capture.res.ver : string
19445 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19446 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19447 persistent flag.
19448
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019449req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019450 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19451 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19452 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019453
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019454req.body_param([<name>) : string
19455 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19456 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19457 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19458 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19459 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19460 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19461 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19462 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19463 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19464 given.
19465
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019466req.body_len : integer
19467 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19468 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019469 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19470 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019471
19472req.body_size : integer
19473 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019474 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19475 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019477req.cook([<name>]) : string
19478cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19479 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19480 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19481 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19482 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19483 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19484 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19485 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19486 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19487
19488 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019489 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19490 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19491 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19492 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19493 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19494 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19495 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19496 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019498req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19499cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19500 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19501 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19504cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19505 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19506 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19507 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19508 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019510cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19511 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19512 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19513 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19514 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019515 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019516 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19517 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19518 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19519 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019521hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19522 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19523 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19524 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19525 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019526 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019528req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019529 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19530 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19531 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19532 with headers such as User-Agent.
19533
19534 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19535 found.
19536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019537 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19538 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19539 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019540 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019542req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19543 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19544 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019545 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19546 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019548req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019549 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19550 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19551 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19552 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19553 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19554 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19555 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19556
19557 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19558 found.
19559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019560 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19561 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19562 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019563 with -1 being the last one.
19564
19565 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19566 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019568 ACL derivatives :
19569 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19570 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19571 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19572 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19573 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19574 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19575 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19576 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19577
19578req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19579hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19580 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19581 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019582 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19583 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19584 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19585
19586 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19587 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19588 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19589
19590 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019591
19592req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19593hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19594 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19595 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19596 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019597 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19598 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19599 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19600 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19601 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019602
19603 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19604
19605 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019606
19607req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19608hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19609 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19610 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19611 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019612
19613 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19614
19615 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019616
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019617req.hdrs : string
19618 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19619 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19620 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19621 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19622
19623req.hdrs_bin : binary
19624 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19625 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19626 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19627 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19628 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19629 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19630
19631 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019632
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019633 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19634 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019636http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19637 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19638 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19639 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19640 basic auth is supported.
19641
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019642http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19643 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19644 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19645 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19646 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019647 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19648 basic auth is supported.
19649
19650 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019651 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19652 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19653 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19654 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019655
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019656http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019657 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19658 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19659 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019660
19661http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019662 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19663 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19664 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019665
19666http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019667 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19668 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19669 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019671http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019672 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19673 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019674 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19675 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019677method : integer + string
19678 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19679 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19680 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19681 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19682 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19683 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19684 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019686 ACL derivatives :
19687 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019689 Example :
19690 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19691 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19692 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019694path : string
19695 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19696 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19697 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19698 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19699 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019700 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019701 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
19702 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
19703 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
19704 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
19705 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019707 ACL derivatives :
19708 path : exact string match
19709 path_beg : prefix match
19710 path_dir : subdir match
19711 path_dom : domain match
19712 path_end : suffix match
19713 path_len : length match
19714 path_reg : regex match
19715 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019716
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019717pathq : string
19718 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19719 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19720 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19721 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19722 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019723 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
19724 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
19725 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
19726 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
19727 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019728
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019729query : string
19730 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19731 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19732 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19733 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019734 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019735 which stops before the question mark.
19736
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019737req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19738 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19739 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19740 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19741 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019743req.ver : string
19744req_ver : string (deprecated)
19745 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19746 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19747 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019749 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019750 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019751
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019752res.body : binary
19753 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19754 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019755 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19756
19757 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019758
19759res.body_len : integer
19760 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19761 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019762 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19763
19764 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019765
19766res.body_size : integer
19767 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19768 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19769 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19770 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019771 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19772
19773 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019774
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019775res.cache_hit : boolean
19776 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19777 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19778
19779res.cache_name : string
19780 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19781 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19782 empty string.
19783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019784res.comp : boolean
19785 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19786 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19787 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019789res.comp_algo : string
19790 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19791 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19792 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019794res.cook([<name>]) : string
19795scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19796 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19797 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019798 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19799
19800 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019802 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019803 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019805res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19806scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19807 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19808 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019809 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19810
19811 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019813res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19814scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19815 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19816 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019817 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19818
19819 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019821res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019822 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19823 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19824
19825 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19826 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19827
19828 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19829
19830 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019832res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019833 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19834 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19835
19836 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19837 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19838
19839 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019841res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19842shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019843 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19844 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19845
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019846 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019847 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19848
19849 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019851 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019852 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19853 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19854 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19855 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19856 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19857 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19858 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19859 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019860
19861res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19862shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019863 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19864 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19865
19866 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019867 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019868
19869 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019871res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19872shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019873 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19874 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19875
19876 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19877
19878 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019879
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019880res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19881 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19882 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19883 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019884 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19885
19886 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019888res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19889shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019890 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19891 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19892
19893 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19894
19895 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019896
19897res.hdrs : string
19898 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19899 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19900 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019901 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19902
19903 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019904
19905res.hdrs_bin : binary
19906 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19907 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19908 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19909 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19910 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19911 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19912 (length of 0 for both).
19913
19914 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19915
19916 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19917 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019919res.ver : string
19920resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19921 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019922 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19923
19924 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019926 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019927 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019929set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19930 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19931 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019932 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019933 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019935 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19936 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019938status : integer
19939 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19940 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019941 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19942
19943 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019944
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019945unique-id : string
19946 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19947 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19948 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19949 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19950 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19951 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019953url : string
19954 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19955 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19956 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19957 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19958 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19959 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019960 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
19961 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
19962 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
19963 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
19964 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019966 ACL derivatives :
19967 url : exact string match
19968 url_beg : prefix match
19969 url_dir : subdir match
19970 url_dom : domain match
19971 url_end : suffix match
19972 url_len : length match
19973 url_reg : regex match
19974 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019976url_ip : ip
19977 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19978 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19979 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19980 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19981 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19982 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19983 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019985url_port : integer
19986 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19987 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19988 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19989 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019990
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019991urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19992url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019993 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19994 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019995 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19996 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19997 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19998 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019999 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20000 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020001 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20002 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020004 ACL derivatives :
20005 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20006 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20007 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20008 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20009 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20010 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20011 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20012 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020013
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020015 Example :
20016 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20017 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20018 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20019 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020020
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020021urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020022 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20023 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20024 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020025
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020026url32 : integer
20027 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20028 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20029 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20030 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20031 is an unsigned integer.
20032
20033url32+src : binary
20034 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20035 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20036 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20037
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020038
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200200397.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020040---------------------------------------
20041
20042This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20043used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20044purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20045There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20046or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20047any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20048for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20049
20050internal.htx.data : integer
20051 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20052 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20053
20054internal.htx.free : integer
20055 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20056 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20057
20058internal.htx.free_data : integer
20059 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20060 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20061
20062internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020063 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20064 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20065 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020066
20067internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20068 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20069 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20070
20071internal.htx.size : integer
20072 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20073 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20074
20075internal.htx.used : integer
20076 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20077 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20078 direction.
20079
20080internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20081 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20082 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20083 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20084 of the special value :
20085 * head : The oldest inserted block
20086 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020087 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020088
20089internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20090 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20091 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20092 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20093 integer or one of the special value :
20094 * head : The oldest inserted block
20095 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020096 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020097
20098internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20099 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20100 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20101 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20102 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20103
20104 * head : The oldest inserted block
20105 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020106 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020107
20108internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20109 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20110 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20111 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20112 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20113
20114 * head : The oldest inserted block
20115 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020116 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020117
20118internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20119 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20120 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20121 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20122 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20123
20124 * head : The oldest inserted block
20125 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020126 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020127
20128internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20129 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20130 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20131 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20132 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20133
20134 * head : The oldest inserted block
20135 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020136 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020137
20138internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20139 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20140 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20141 it returns false.
20142
20143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200201447.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020145---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020147Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20148every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020149order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020151ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020152---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20153FALSE always_false never match
20154HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20155HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20156HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020157HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020158HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20159HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20160HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20161HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20162LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20163METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20164METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20165METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20166METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20167METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20168METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20169METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20170METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20171RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20172REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20173TRUE always_true always match
20174WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20175---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020176
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201788. Logging
20179----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020180
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020181One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20182provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20183very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20184provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20185state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020186to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020187headers.
20188
20189In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20190about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20191send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20192
20193 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20194 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20195 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20196 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20197 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020198 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020199 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020200
20201The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20202allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20203as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20204while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20205real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20206delay.
20207
20208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202098.1. Log levels
20210---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020211
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020212TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020213source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020214HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20215in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20216track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20217syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20218about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020219
20220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202218.2. Log formats
20222----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020223
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020224HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020225and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20226slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20227options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020228
20229 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20230 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20231 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20232 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20233 extents.
20234
20235 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20236 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20237 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20238 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20239 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20240
20241 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20242 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20243 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20244 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20245 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20246
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020247 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20248 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20249 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20250 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20251
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020252 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20253
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020254Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20255specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20256field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20257servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20258always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20259identifier.
20260
20261Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20262 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20263 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20264 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20265 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20266
20267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202688.2.1. Default log format
20269-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020270
20271This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20272as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20273format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20274
20275 Example :
20276 listen www
20277 mode http
20278 log global
20279 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20280
20281 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20282 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20283 (www/HTTP)
20284
20285 Field Format Extract from the example above
20286 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20287 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20288 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20289 4 'to' to
20290 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20291 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20292
20293Detailed fields description :
20294 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20295 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20296 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20297 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20298 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20299 and processed the connection.
20300 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20301
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020302In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20303"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20304connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20305
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020306It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20307will eventually disappear.
20308
20309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203108.2.2. TCP log format
20311---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020312
20313The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20314is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20315information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20316counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20317emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20318environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20319the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20320sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020321specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20322not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20323fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20324marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020325
20326 Example :
20327 frontend fnt
20328 mode tcp
20329 option tcplog
20330 log global
20331 default_backend bck
20332
20333 backend bck
20334 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20335
20336 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20337 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20338 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20339
20340 Field Format Extract from the example above
20341 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20342 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20343 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20344 4 frontend_name fnt
20345 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20346 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20347 7 bytes_read* 212
20348 8 termination_state --
20349 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20350 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20351
20352Detailed fields description :
20353 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020354 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020355 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20356 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020357 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020358 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020359 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020360
20361 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020362 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20363 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20364 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020365
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020366 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020367 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20368 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020369 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20370 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20371 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20372 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020373
20374 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20375 and processed the connection.
20376
20377 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20378 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20379 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20380 applications.
20381
20382 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20383 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20384 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20385 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20386 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20387
20388 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20389 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20390 See "Timers" below for more details.
20391
20392 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20393 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20394 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20395 "Timers" below for more details.
20396
20397 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020398 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020399 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20400 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20401 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20402 details.
20403
20404 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20405 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20406 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20407 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20408 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20409
20410 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20411 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20412 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20413 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20414 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20415 for more details.
20416
20417 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020418 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020419 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20420 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20421 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020422 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020423
20424 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20425 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20426 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20427 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20428 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20429 caused by a denial of service attack.
20430
20431 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20432 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20433 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20434 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20435 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20436 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20437 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20438 denial of service attack.
20439
20440 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20441 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20442 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20443 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20444 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20445 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20446 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20447 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20448 be processed than on other servers.
20449
20450 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20451 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20452 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20453 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020454 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020455 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20456 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20457 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20458 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20459 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20460 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20461 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20462 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20463
20464 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20465 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20466 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20467 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20468 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20469 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020470 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020471 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20472
20473 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20474 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20475 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20476 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20477 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20478 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020479 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020480 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20481 occurs.
20482
20483
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204848.2.3. HTTP log format
20485----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020486
20487The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20488is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20489the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20490are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20491emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20492generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20493"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20494which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020495frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20496is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020497
20498Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20499slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20500with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20501
20502 Example :
20503 frontend http-in
20504 mode http
20505 option httplog
20506 log global
20507 default_backend bck
20508
20509 backend static
20510 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20511
20512 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20513 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20514 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020515 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020516
20517 Field Format Extract from the example above
20518 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20519 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020520 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020521 4 frontend_name http-in
20522 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020523 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020524 7 status_code 200
20525 8 bytes_read* 2750
20526 9 captured_request_cookie -
20527 10 captured_response_cookie -
20528 11 termination_state ----
20529 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20530 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20531 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20532 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20533 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020534
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020535Detailed fields description :
20536 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020537 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020538 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20539 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020540 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020541 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020542 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020543
20544 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020545 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20546 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20547 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020548
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020549 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020550 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020551
20552 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20553 and processed the connection.
20554
20555 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20556 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20557 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20558
20559 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20560 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20561 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20562 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20563 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20564 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20565
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020566 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20567 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20568 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020569 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020570 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20571 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020572 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020573 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020574
20575 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20576 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020577 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020578
20579 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20580 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020581 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20582 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020583
20584 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20585 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20586 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20587 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20588 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020589 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20590 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020592 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020593 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20594 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20595 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20596 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20597 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20598 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020599 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020600
20601 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020602 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20603 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020604
20605 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20606 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020607 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020608 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20609 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20610 overflowing.
20611
20612 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20613 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20614 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20615 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20616 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20617 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20618 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20619 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20620
20621 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20622 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20623 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20624 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20625 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20626 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20627 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20628 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20629
20630 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20631 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20632 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20633 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20634 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20635 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20636 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20637
20638 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020639 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020640 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20641 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20642 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020643 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020644 system.
20645
20646 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20647 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20648 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20649 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20650 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20651 caused by a denial of service attack.
20652
20653 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20654 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20655 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20656 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20657 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20658 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20659 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20660 denial of service attack.
20661
20662 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20663 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20664 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20665 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20666 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20667 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20668 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20669 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20670 processed than on other servers.
20671
20672 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20673 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20674 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20675 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020676 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020677 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20678 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20679 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20680 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20681 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20682 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20683 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20684 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20685
20686 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20687 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20688 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20689 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20690 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20691 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020692 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020693 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20694
20695 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20696 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20697 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20698 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20699 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20700 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020701 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020702 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20703 occurs.
20704
20705 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20706 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20707 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20708 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20709 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20710 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20711 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20712 cookies" below for more details.
20713
20714 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20715 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20716 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20717 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20718 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20719 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20720 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20721 and cookies" below for more details.
20722
20723 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20724 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20725 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20726 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20727 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20728 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20729 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20730 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20731
20732
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200207338.2.4. Custom log format
20734------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020735
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020736The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020737mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020738
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020739HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020740Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20741separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20742prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20743
20744Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20745variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020746("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020747
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020748If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020749as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020750less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20751the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20752
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020753Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20754"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20755delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20756preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020757
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020758Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20759'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20760https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20761such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20762
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020763Flags are :
20764 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020765 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020766 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20767 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020768
20769 Example:
20770
20771 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20772 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20773
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020774 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20775
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020776At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20777
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020778 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20779 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020780
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020781the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020782
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020783 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20784 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20785 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020786
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020787and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20788
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020789 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20790 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020791
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020792Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20793
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020794 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020795 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020796 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20797 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20798 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020799 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20800 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20801 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020802 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020803 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020804 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020805 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020806 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020807 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20808 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020809 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020810 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020811 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020812 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020813 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020814 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020815 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020816 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20817 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20818 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20819 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20820 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020821 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020822 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020823 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020824 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020825 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020826 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20827 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020828 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20829 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20830 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020831 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020832 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20833 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020834 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020835 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20836 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20837 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020838 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020839 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020840 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20841 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20842 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20843 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020844 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020845 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020846 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020847 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020848 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020849 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020850 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20851 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20852 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020853 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020854 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20855 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020856 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020857 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20858 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020859 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020860 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020861 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020862 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020863
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020864 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020865
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020866
208678.2.5. Error log format
20868-----------------------
20869
20870When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020871protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020872By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20873"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020874will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020875logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20876
20877The format looks like this :
20878
20879 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20880 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20881 Connection error during SSL handshake
20882
20883 Field Format Extract from the example above
20884 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20885 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20886 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20887 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20888 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20889
20890These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20891failures.
20892
20893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208948.3. Advanced logging options
20895-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020896
20897Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20898just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20899options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20900for more information about their usage.
20901
20902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20904------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020905
20906It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020907HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020908commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20909monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20910ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20911
20912 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20913 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20914 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20915 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20916
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020917 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20918 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020919
20920 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20921 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20922 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20923
20924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209258.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20926----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020927
20928The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20929what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20930or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020931"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020932just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20933log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20934after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20935is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20936with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20937with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20938
20939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209408.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20941------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020942
20943Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20944for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20945"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20946retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20947raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20948a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20949file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20950you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20951"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20952
20953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209548.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20955--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020956
20957Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20958multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20959them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20960"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20961logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20962error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20963and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20964too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20965useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20966alternative.
20967
20968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209698.4. Timing events
20970------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020971
20972Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20973reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20974the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20975frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020976mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20977addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20978
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020979Timings events in HTTP mode:
20980
20981 first request 2nd request
20982 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20983 t tr t tr ...
20984 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20985 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20986 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20987 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020988 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020989 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20990
20991Timings events in TCP mode:
20992
20993 TCP session
20994 |<----------------->|
20995 t t
20996 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20997 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20998 |<------ Tt ------->|
20999
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021000 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021001 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021002 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21003 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21004 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021005 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021006 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21007 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21008 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21009 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021010
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021011 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21012 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21013 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021014 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21015 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21016 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21017 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21018 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21019 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021020
21021 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21022 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21023 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21024 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21025 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21026 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21027 request typed by hand during a test.
21028
21029 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21030 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021031 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021032 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21033 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21034 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21035 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021036
21037 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21038 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21039 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21040 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21041 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21042
21043 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21044 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21045 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21046 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21047 connection never established.
21048
21049 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21050 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21051 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21052 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21053 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21054 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21055 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21056 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21057 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21058 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21059 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21060
William Lallemand90b82122023-07-25 09:06:51 +020021061 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
21062 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
21063 (after Tr).
21064
21065 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
21066 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
21067
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021068 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21069 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21070 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21071 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21072 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21073 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21074
21075 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21076
21077 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21078 "Ta" can never be negative.
21079
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021080 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21081 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021082 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21083 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021084 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021085
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021086 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021087
21088 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021089 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21090 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021091
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021092 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21093 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21094 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21095 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21096 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21097 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21098 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21099 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21100
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021101These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21102protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21103that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021104due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21105"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21106that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021107
21108Most common cases :
21109
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021110 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21111 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21112 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21113 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21114 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021115 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021116 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21117 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21118 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21119 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21120 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021121 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021122
21123 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21124 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21125 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21126 of ms on remote networks.
21127
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021128 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21129 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21130 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021131
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021132 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21133 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021134 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021135 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21136 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21137 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21138 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21139 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21140 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021141
21142Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21143
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021144 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021145 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021146 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021147
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021148 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021149 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21150 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21151
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021152 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021153 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21154 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21155 flags.
21156
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021157 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21158 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021159 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21160 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21161 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21162 the client connection was maintained open.
21163
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021164 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021165 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021166 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021167 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21168
21169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211708.5. Session state at disconnection
21171-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021172
21173TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21174"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
211752-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21176each of which has a special meaning :
21177
21178 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21179 session to terminate :
21180
21181 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21182
21183 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21184 server explicitly refused it.
21185
21186 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21187 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21188 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21189 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021190 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021191
Christopher Fauletdd8abeb2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010021192 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021193
21194 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21195 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21196 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21197 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21198 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21199
21200 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21201 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21202 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21203 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21204 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21205
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021206 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021207 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21208
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021209 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021210 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21211 backup connections when going up.
21212
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021213 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021214
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021215 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21216 send or receive data.
21217
21218 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21219 send or receive data.
21220
21221 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21222 with nothing left in the buffers.
21223
21224 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21225
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021226 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021227 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21228
21229 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21230 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21231 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21232 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21233 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21234
21235 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21236 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21237
21238 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21239 server (HTTP only).
21240
21241 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21242
21243 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21244 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21245 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21246
21247 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21248 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21249 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21250
21251 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21252
21253 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21254 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21255
21256 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21257 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21258 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21259
21260 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21261 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021262 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21263 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021264
21265 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21266 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21267 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21268 another server.
21269
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021270 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021271 server.
21272
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021273 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21274 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21275 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21276 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21277
21278 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21279 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21280 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21281 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21282
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021283 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21284 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21285 "use-server" rule).
21286
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021287 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21288
21289 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21290 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21291
21292 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21293
21294 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21295 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21296 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21297
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021298 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21299 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021300 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021301 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21302 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21303
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021304 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21305
21306 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21307 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21308
21309 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21310
21311 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21312
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021313The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21314was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021315helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21316starvation, attacks, etc...
21317
21318The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21319alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21320easier finding and understanding.
21321
21322 Flags Reason
21323
21324 -- Normal termination.
21325
21326 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021327 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21328 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021329 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21330
21331 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21332 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021333 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21334 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021335 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21336 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021337
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021338 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21339 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021340 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021341
21342 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21343 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21344 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21345
21346 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21347 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21348 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21349 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21350 the server takes too long to respond.
21351
21352 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21353 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21354 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21355 long a time to respond.
21356
21357 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21358 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21359 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021360 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021361 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21362 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021363
21364 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21365 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21366 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21367 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21368 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021369 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021370 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21371 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21372 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21373 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21374 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21375 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21376 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21377 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021378 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021379 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21380 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21381 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021382
21383 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21384 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021385 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21386 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21387 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21388 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021389
Christopher Fauletdd8abeb2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010021390 LC The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
21391 request was not sent to the server. It only happens with a redirect
21392 because of a "redir" parameter on the server line.
21393
21394 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
21395 request was not sent to the server. Generally it means a redirect was
21396 returned, an HTTP return statement was processed or the request was
21397 handled by an applet (stats, cache, Prometheus exported, lua applet...).
21398
21399 LH The response was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
21400 it means a redirect was returned or an HTTP return statement was
21401 processed.
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021402
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021403 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021404 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21405 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021406 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021407 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21408 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21409
21410 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21411 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21412 503 or 504 here.
21413
21414 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021415 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021416 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21417 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21418 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21419
21420 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21421 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021422 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021423 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021424 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021425
21426 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21427 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21428 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21429 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21430 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21431 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021432 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021433
21434 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21435 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21436 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21437 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21438 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21439 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21440 solution is to fix the application.
21441
21442 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21443 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21444 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21445 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21446 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21447 external attacks.
21448
21449 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021450 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021451 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021452 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21453 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21454
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021455 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21456 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21457 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021458 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021459 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021460
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021461 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21462 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21463 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21464 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021465 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21466 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21467 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21468 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021469 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21470 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21471 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21472 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021473
21474 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21475 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21476 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021477 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21478 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21479 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21480 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021481
21482 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21483 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21484 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21485 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21486
21487 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21488 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21489 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21490 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21491
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021492The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021493persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021494important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21495re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21496
21497 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21498
21499 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21500 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21501 set on a GET request.
21502
21503 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21504 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021505 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021506 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21507
21508 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21509 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21510 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21511
21512 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21513 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21514 already got a cookie.
21515
21516 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21517 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21518 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21519 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21520 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21521
21522 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21523 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21524 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21525
21526 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21527 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21528 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21529
21530 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21531 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21532
21533 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21534 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21535 then advertised in the response.
21536
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215388.6. Non-printable characters
21539-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021540
21541In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21542consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21543converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21544prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21545being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21546escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21547is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21548'}' when logging headers.
21549
21550Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21551issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21552containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21553
21554Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21555the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21556performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21557
21558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215598.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21560---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021561
21562Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21563achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021564section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021565cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21566the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21567the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021568locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021569not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21570user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21571a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21572wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21573
21574 Examples :
21575 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21576 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21577
21578 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21579 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21580
21581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215828.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21583---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021584
21585Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21586proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21587the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21588server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21589
21590Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21591response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021592section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021593
21594It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021595time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21596appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021597are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21598and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21599follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21600request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21601in the logs.
21602
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021603As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21604frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21605an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21606
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021607 Example :
21608 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21609 listen proxy-out
21610 mode http
21611 option httplog
21612 option logasap
21613 log global
21614 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21615
21616 # log the name of the virtual server
21617 capture request header Host len 20
21618
21619 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21620 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21621
21622 # log the beginning of the referrer
21623 capture request header Referer len 20
21624
21625 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21626 capture response header Server len 20
21627
21628 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21629 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21630
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021631 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021632 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21633
21634 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21635 capture response header Via len 20
21636
21637 # log the URL location during a redirection
21638 capture response header Location len 20
21639
21640 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21641 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21642 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21643 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21644 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21645
21646 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21647 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21648 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21649 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021650 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021651
21652 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21653 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21654 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21655 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21656 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021657 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021658
21659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216608.9. Examples of logs
21661---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021662
21663These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21664them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21665reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21666
21667 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21668 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21669 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21670
21671 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21672 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21673
21674 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21675 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21676 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21677
21678 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21679 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21680
21681 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21682 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21683 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21684
21685 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021686 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021687 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21688 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21689
21690 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21691 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21692 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21693
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021694 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21695 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21696 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21697 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021698 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021699 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021700
21701 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021702 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021703
21704 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21705 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21706 Nothing was sent to any server.
21707
21708 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21709 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21710
21711 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21712 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021713 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021714 send a 408 return code to the client.
21715
21716 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21717 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21718
21719 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21720 5 seconds ("c----").
21721
21722 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21723 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021724 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021725
21726 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021727 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021728 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21729 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21730 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21731 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21732 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021733
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021734
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200217359. Supported filters
21736--------------------
21737
21738Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21739accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21740unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21741
21742See also : "filter"
21743
217449.1. Trace
21745----------
21746
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021747filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021748
21749 Arguments:
21750 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21751 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21752
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021753 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021754
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021755 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021756 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21757 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21758 amount of the parsed data.
21759
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021760 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021761
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021762This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21763callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21764information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21765filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21766
21767Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21768tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21769a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21770
21771
217729.2. HTTP compression
21773---------------------
21774
21775filter compression
21776
21777The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21778keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021779when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21780fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21781done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21782explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21783filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21784listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21785order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021786
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021787See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21788 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021789
21790
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200217919.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21792--------------------------------------------
21793
21794filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21795
21796 Arguments :
21797
21798 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21799 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21800 parsed.
21801
21802 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21803 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21804 part must be placed in its own scope.
21805
21806The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21807external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021808streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021809exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21810also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21811
21812SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21813the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21814
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021815For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021816"doc/SPOE.txt".
21817
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100218189.4. Cache
21819----------
21820
21821filter cache <name>
21822
21823 Arguments :
21824
21825 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21826
21827The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21828"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021829cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021830other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21831case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21832is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21833filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021834listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21835order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021836
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021837See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21838 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21839
21840
218419.5. Fcgi-app
21842-------------
21843
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021844filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021845
21846 Arguments :
21847
21848 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21849
21850The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21851request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21852reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21853used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21854implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21855used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21856fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21857used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21858order.
21859
21860See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21861 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21862
21863
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100218649.6. OpenTracing
21865----------------
21866
21867The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21868HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21869of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21870Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21871
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021872This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021873
21874The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21875HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21876participates in the work of HAProxy.
21877
21878filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21879
21880 Arguments :
21881
21882 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21883 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21884 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21885 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21886 OpenTracing filters.
21887
21888 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21889 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21890 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21891 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21892 filter must have its own scope defined.
21893
21894More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021895of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021896
21897
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002189810. FastCGI applications
21899-------------------------
21900
21901HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21902feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21903the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21904FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21905servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21906FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21907backend.
21908
21909HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21910application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21911connection.
21912
2191310.1. Setup
21914-----------
21915
2191610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21917--------------------------
21918
21919fcgi-app <name>
21920 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21921 document root must be defined.
21922
21923acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21924 Declare or complete an access list.
21925
21926 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21927 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21928 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21929 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21930 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21931
21932docroot <path>
21933 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21934 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21935 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21936
21937index <script-name>
21938 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21939 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21940 is an optional setting.
21941
21942 Example :
21943 index index.php
21944
21945log-stderr global
21946log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021947 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021948 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21949
21950 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21951 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21952
21953pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21954 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21955 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21956 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21957
21958 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21959 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21960 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21961 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21962
21963 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21964 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21965
21966path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021967 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021968 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21969 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21970 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21971 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21972 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21973 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21974 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021975
21976 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021977 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021978 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21979 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21980 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21981 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021982
21983 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021984 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21985 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021986
21987option get-values
21988no option get-values
21989 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21990
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021991 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021992 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21993
21994 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21995 application will accept.
21996
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021997 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21998 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021999
22000 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022001 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022002 option is disabled.
22003
22004 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22005 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22006 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22007 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22008 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22009 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22010
22011option keep-conn
22012no option keep-conn
22013 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22014 sending a response.
22015
22016 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22017 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22018
22019option max-reqs <reqs>
22020 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22021 accept.
22022
22023 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22024 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22025 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22026 to 1.
22027
22028option mpxs-conns
22029no option mpxs-conns
22030 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22031
22032 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22033 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22034
22035set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22036 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22037 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22038 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22039 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22040
22041 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22042 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22043 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22044
22045 Example :
22046 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22047 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22048
22049 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22050
22051
2205210.1.2. Proxy section
22053---------------------
22054
22055use-fcgi-app <name>
22056 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22057
22058 Arguments :
22059 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22060
22061 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22062 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22063 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22064 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22065 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22066
22067 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22068 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22069 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22070 application are evaluated.
22071
22072
2207310.1.3. Example
22074---------------
22075
22076 frontend front-http
22077 mode http
22078 bind *:80
22079 bind *:
22080
22081 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22082 default_backend back-static
22083
22084 backend back-static
22085 mode http
22086 server www A.B.C.D:80
22087
22088 backend back-dynamic
22089 mode http
22090 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22091 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22092
22093 fcgi-app php-fpm
22094 log-stderr global
22095 option keep-conn
22096
22097 docroot /var/www/my-app
22098 index index.php
22099 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22100
22101
2210210.2. Default parameters
22103------------------------
22104
22105A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22106the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022107script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022108applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22109
22110 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22111 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22112 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22113 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22114 | | |
22115 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22116 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22117 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22118 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22119 | | application. |
22120 | | |
22121 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22122 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22123 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22124 | | |
22125 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22126 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22127 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22128 | | the application's configuration. |
22129 | | |
22130 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22131 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22132 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22133 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22134 | | |
22135 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22136 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22137 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22138 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22139 | | be defined. |
22140 | | |
22141 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22142 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22143 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22144 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22145 | | is not set too. |
22146 | | |
22147 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22148 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22149 | | set. |
22150 | | |
22151 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22152 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22153 | | the request. |
22154 | | |
22155 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22156 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22157 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22158 | | |
22159 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22160 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22161 | | script to process the request. |
22162 | | |
22163 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22164 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22165 | | |
22166 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22167 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22168 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22169 | | |
22170 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22171 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22172 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22173 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22174 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22175 | | |
22176 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22177 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22178 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22179 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22180 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22181 | | side. |
22182 | | |
22183 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22184 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22185 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22186 | | connected to. |
22187 | | |
22188 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22189 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22190 | | |
22191 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022192 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22193 | | current HAProxy version. |
22194 | | |
22195 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022196 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22197 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22198 | | |
22199 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22200
22201
2220210.3. Limitations
22203------------------
22204
22205The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22206way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22207during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22208establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22209application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22210or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22211message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22212these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22213and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22214
22215Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22216request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22217requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22218
22219About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22220into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22221fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22222"http-request" ones.
22223
22224Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22225FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22226processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22227must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22228here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022229
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022230
2223111. Address formats
22232-------------------
22233
22234Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22235address.
22236
22237This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22238The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22239of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22240equivalent is '::'.
22241
22242Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22243is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22244
22245This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22246family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22247
22248Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22249configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22250use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22251'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22252
22253Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22254socket type and the transport method.
22255
22256
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002225711.1. Address family prefixes
22258-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022259
22260'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22261
22262'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22263 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22264 listening.
22265
22266'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22267 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22268 on the statement using this address, a port or
22269 a port range may or must be specified.
22270
22271'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22272 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22273 using this address, a port or a port range
22274 may or must be specified.
22275
22276'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22277 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22278 using this address, a port or a port range
22279 may or must be specified.
22280
22281'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22282 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22283 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22284 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22285 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22286 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22287
22288'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22289 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22290 start by slash '/'.
22291
22292
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002229311.2. Socket type prefixes
22294--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022295
22296Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22297type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22298this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22299This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22300but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22301
22302Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
Willy Tarreaudc2b3f82023-01-16 12:07:12 +010022303instead use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes".
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022304
22305If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22306they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22307report this to the maintainers.
22308
22309'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22310 to "stream"
22311
22312'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22313 to "datagram".
22314
22315
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002231611.3. Protocol prefixes
22317-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022318
22319'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22320 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22321 socket type and transport method is forced to
22322 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22323 this address, a port or a port range can or
22324 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22325 of 'stream+ip@'.
22326
22327'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22328 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22329 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22330 statement using this address, a port or port
22331 range can or must be specified.
22332 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22333
22334'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22335 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22336 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22337 statement using this address, a port or port
22338 range can or must be specified.
22339 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22340
22341'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22342 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22343 socket type and transport method is forced to
22344 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22345 this address, a port or a port range can or
22346 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22347 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22348
22349'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22350 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22351 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22352 the statement using this address, a port or
22353 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022354 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022355
22356'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22357 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22358 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22359 the statement using this address, a port or
22360 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022361 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022362
22363'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22364 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22365 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22366
22367'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22368 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22369 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22370
22371In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22372QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022374/*
22375 * Local variables:
22376 * fill-column: 79
22377 * End:
22378 */